PowerPC PIC vs. DLL TLS issues
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / bfd / elf32-ppc.c
1 /* PowerPC-specific support for 32-bit ELF
2 Copyright (C) 1994-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 Written by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support.
4
5 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program; if not, write to the
19 Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor,
20 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
21
22
23 /* This file is based on a preliminary PowerPC ELF ABI. The
24 information may not match the final PowerPC ELF ABI. It includes
25 suggestions from the in-progress Embedded PowerPC ABI, and that
26 information may also not match. */
27
28 #include "sysdep.h"
29 #include <stdarg.h>
30 #include "bfd.h"
31 #include "bfdlink.h"
32 #include "libbfd.h"
33 #include "elf-bfd.h"
34 #include "elf/ppc.h"
35 #include "elf32-ppc.h"
36 #include "elf-vxworks.h"
37 #include "dwarf2.h"
38 #include "opcode/ppc.h"
39
40 typedef enum split16_format_type
41 {
42 split16a_type = 0,
43 split16d_type
44 }
45 split16_format_type;
46
47 /* RELA relocations are used here. */
48
49 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc
50 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
51 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc
52 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
53
54 /* Branch prediction bit for branch taken relocs. */
55 #define BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT 0x200000
56 /* Mask to set RA in memory instructions. */
57 #define RA_REGISTER_MASK 0x001f0000
58 /* Value to shift register by to insert RA. */
59 #define RA_REGISTER_SHIFT 16
60
61 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp
62 section. */
63 #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER "/usr/lib/ld.so.1"
64
65 /* For old-style PLT. */
66 /* The number of single-slot PLT entries (the rest use two slots). */
67 #define PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES 8192
68
69 /* For new-style .glink and .plt. */
70 #define GLINK_PLTRESOLVE 16*4
71 #define GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE(htab, h) \
72 ((4*4 \
73 + (h != NULL \
74 && h == htab->tls_get_addr \
75 && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt ? 8*4 : 0) \
76 + (1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align) - 1) \
77 & -(1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align))
78
79 /* VxWorks uses its own plt layout, filled in by the static linker. */
80
81 /* The standard VxWorks PLT entry. */
82 #define VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE 32
83 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry
84 [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
85 {
86 0x3d800000, /* lis r12,0 */
87 0x818c0000, /* lwz r12,0(r12) */
88 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
89 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
90 0x39600000, /* li r11,0 */
91 0x48000000, /* b 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> */
92 0x60000000, /* nop */
93 0x60000000, /* nop */
94 };
95 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
96 [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
97 {
98 0x3d9e0000, /* addis r12,r30,0 */
99 0x818c0000, /* lwz r12,0(r12) */
100 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
101 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
102 0x39600000, /* li r11,0 */
103 0x48000000, /* b 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> 14: R_PPC_REL24 .PLTresolve */
104 0x60000000, /* nop */
105 0x60000000, /* nop */
106 };
107
108 /* The initial VxWorks PLT entry. */
109 #define VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE 32
110 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry
111 [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
112 {
113 0x3d800000, /* lis r12,0 */
114 0x398c0000, /* addi r12,r12,0 */
115 0x800c0008, /* lwz r0,8(r12) */
116 0x7c0903a6, /* mtctr r0 */
117 0x818c0004, /* lwz r12,4(r12) */
118 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
119 0x60000000, /* nop */
120 0x60000000, /* nop */
121 };
122 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
123 [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
124 {
125 0x819e0008, /* lwz r12,8(r30) */
126 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
127 0x819e0004, /* lwz r12,4(r30) */
128 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
129 0x60000000, /* nop */
130 0x60000000, /* nop */
131 0x60000000, /* nop */
132 0x60000000, /* nop */
133 };
134
135 /* For executables, we have some additional relocations in
136 .rela.plt.unloaded, for the kernel loader. */
137
138 /* The number of non-JMP_SLOT relocations per PLT0 slot. */
139 #define VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS 3
140 /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot. */
141 #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS 2
142 /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot when creating
143 a shared library. */
144 #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS_SHLIB 0
145
146 /* Some instructions. */
147 #define ADDIS_11_11 0x3d6b0000
148 #define ADDIS_11_30 0x3d7e0000
149 #define ADDIS_12_12 0x3d8c0000
150 #define ADDI_11_11 0x396b0000
151 #define ADD_0_11_11 0x7c0b5a14
152 #define ADD_3_12_2 0x7c6c1214
153 #define ADD_11_0_11 0x7d605a14
154 #define B 0x48000000
155 #define BA 0x48000002
156 #define BCL_20_31 0x429f0005
157 #define BCTR 0x4e800420
158 #define BEQLR 0x4d820020
159 #define CMPWI_11_0 0x2c0b0000
160 #define LIS_11 0x3d600000
161 #define LIS_12 0x3d800000
162 #define LWZU_0_12 0x840c0000
163 #define LWZ_0_12 0x800c0000
164 #define LWZ_11_3 0x81630000
165 #define LWZ_11_11 0x816b0000
166 #define LWZ_11_30 0x817e0000
167 #define LWZ_12_3 0x81830000
168 #define LWZ_12_12 0x818c0000
169 #define MR_0_3 0x7c601b78
170 #define MR_3_0 0x7c030378
171 #define MFLR_0 0x7c0802a6
172 #define MFLR_12 0x7d8802a6
173 #define MTCTR_0 0x7c0903a6
174 #define MTCTR_11 0x7d6903a6
175 #define MTLR_0 0x7c0803a6
176 #define NOP 0x60000000
177 #define SUB_11_11_12 0x7d6c5850
178
179 /* Offset of tp and dtp pointers from start of TLS block. */
180 #define TP_OFFSET 0x7000
181 #define DTP_OFFSET 0x8000
182
183 /* The value of a defined global symbol. */
184 #define SYM_VAL(SYM) \
185 ((SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma \
186 + (SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_offset \
187 + (SYM)->root.u.def.value)
188 \f
189 /* Relocation HOWTO's. */
190 /* Like other ELF RELA targets that don't apply multiple
191 field-altering relocations to the same localation, src_mask is
192 always zero and pcrel_offset is the same as pc_relative.
193 PowerPC can always use a zero bitpos, even when the field is not at
194 the LSB. For example, a REL24 could use rightshift=2, bisize=24
195 and bitpos=2 which matches the ABI description, or as we do here,
196 rightshift=0, bitsize=26 and bitpos=0. */
197 #define HOW(type, size, bitsize, mask, rightshift, pc_relative, \
198 complain, special_func) \
199 HOWTO (type, rightshift, size, bitsize, pc_relative, 0, \
200 complain_overflow_ ## complain, special_func, \
201 #type, FALSE, 0, mask, pc_relative)
202
203 static reloc_howto_type *ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_max];
204
205 static reloc_howto_type ppc_elf_howto_raw[] = {
206 /* This reloc does nothing. */
207 HOW (R_PPC_NONE, 3, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
208 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
209
210 /* A standard 32 bit relocation. */
211 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
212 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
213
214 /* An absolute 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
215 FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
216 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
217 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
218
219 /* A standard 16 bit relocation. */
220 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
221 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
222
223 /* A 16 bit relocation without overflow. */
224 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
225 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
226
227 /* The high order 16 bits of an address. */
228 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
229 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
230
231 /* The high order 16 bits of an address, plus 1 if the contents of
232 the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
233 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
234 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
235
236 /* An absolute 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
237 FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
238 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
239 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
240
241 /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
242 indicate that the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two
243 bits must be zero. */
244 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
245 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
246
247 /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
248 indicate that the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower
249 two bits must be zero. */
250 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
251 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
252
253 /* A relative 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
254 HOW (R_PPC_REL24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
255 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
256
257 /* A relative 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
258 HOW (R_PPC_REL14, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
259 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
260
261 /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
262 the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two bits must be
263 zero. */
264 HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
265 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
266
267 /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
268 the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower two bits must
269 be zero. */
270 HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
271 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
272
273 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but referring to the GOT table entry for the
274 symbol. */
275 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
276 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
277
278 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the GOT table entry for
279 the symbol. */
280 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
281 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
282
283 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the GOT table entry for
284 the symbol. */
285 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
286 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
287
288 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the GOT table entry for
289 the symbol. */
290 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
291 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
292
293 /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but referring to the procedure linkage table
294 entry for the symbol. */
295 HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
296 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
297
298 /* This is used only by the dynamic linker. The symbol should exist
299 both in the object being run and in some shared library. The
300 dynamic linker copies the data addressed by the symbol from the
301 shared library into the object, because the object being
302 run has to have the data at some particular address. */
303 HOW (R_PPC_COPY, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
304 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
305
306 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but used when setting global offset table
307 entries. */
308 HOW (R_PPC_GLOB_DAT, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
309 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
310
311 /* Marks a procedure linkage table entry for a symbol. */
312 HOW (R_PPC_JMP_SLOT, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
313 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
314
315 /* Used only by the dynamic linker. When the object is run, this
316 longword is set to the load address of the object, plus the
317 addend. */
318 HOW (R_PPC_RELATIVE, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
319 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
320
321 /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but uses the value of the symbol within the
322 object rather than the final value. Normally used for
323 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
324 HOW (R_PPC_LOCAL24PC, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
325 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
326
327 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but may be unaligned. */
328 HOW (R_PPC_UADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
329 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
330
331 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but may be unaligned. */
332 HOW (R_PPC_UADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
333 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
334
335 /* 32-bit PC relative */
336 HOW (R_PPC_REL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, TRUE, dont,
337 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
338
339 /* 32-bit relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
340 FIXME: not supported. */
341 HOW (R_PPC_PLT32, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
342 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
343
344 /* 32-bit PC relative relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
345 FIXME: not supported. */
346 HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL32, 2, 32, 0, 0, TRUE, dont,
347 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
348
349 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the PLT table entry for
350 the symbol. */
351 HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
352 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
353
354 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the PLT table entry for
355 the symbol. */
356 HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
357 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
358
359 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the PLT table entry for
360 the symbol. */
361 HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
362 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
363
364 /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA_BASE_, for use with
365 small data items. */
366 HOW (R_PPC_SDAREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
367 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
368
369 /* 16-bit section relative relocation. */
370 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
371 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
372
373 /* 16-bit lower half section relative relocation. */
374 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
375 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
376
377 /* 16-bit upper half section relative relocation. */
378 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
379 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
380
381 /* 16-bit upper half adjusted section relative relocation. */
382 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
383 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
384
385 /* Marker relocs for TLS. */
386 HOW (R_PPC_TLS, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
387 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
388
389 HOW (R_PPC_TLSGD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
390 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
391
392 HOW (R_PPC_TLSLD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
393 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
394
395 /* Marker relocs on inline plt call instructions. */
396 HOW (R_PPC_PLTSEQ, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
397 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
398
399 HOW (R_PPC_PLTCALL, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
400 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
401
402 /* Computes the load module index of the load module that contains the
403 definition of its TLS sym. */
404 HOW (R_PPC_DTPMOD32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
405 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
406
407 /* Computes a dtv-relative displacement, the difference between the value
408 of sym+add and the base address of the thread-local storage block that
409 contains the definition of sym, minus 0x8000. */
410 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
411 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
412
413 /* A 16 bit dtprel reloc. */
414 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
415 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
416
417 /* Like DTPREL16, but no overflow. */
418 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
419 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
420
421 /* Like DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
422 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
423 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
424
425 /* Like DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
426 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
427 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
428
429 /* Computes a tp-relative displacement, the difference between the value of
430 sym+add and the value of the thread pointer (r13). */
431 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
432 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
433
434 /* A 16 bit tprel reloc. */
435 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
436 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
437
438 /* Like TPREL16, but no overflow. */
439 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
440 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
441
442 /* Like TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
443 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
444 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
445
446 /* Like TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
447 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
448 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
449
450 /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
451 with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes the offset
452 to the first entry. */
453 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
454 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
455
456 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16, but no overflow. */
457 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
458 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
459
460 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
461 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
462 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
463
464 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
465 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
466 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
467
468 /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
469 with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and zero, and computes the offset to the
470 first entry. */
471 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
472 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
473
474 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16, but no overflow. */
475 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
476 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
477
478 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
479 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
480 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
481
482 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
483 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
484 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
485
486 /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes
487 the offset to the entry. */
488 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
489 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
490
491 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16, but no overflow. */
492 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
493 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
494
495 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
496 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
497 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
498
499 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
500 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
501 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
502
503 /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@tprel, and computes the
504 offset to the entry. */
505 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
506 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
507
508 /* Like GOT_TPREL16, but no overflow. */
509 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
510 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
511
512 /* Like GOT_TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
513 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
514 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
515
516 /* Like GOT_TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
517 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
518 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
519
520 /* The remaining relocs are from the Embedded ELF ABI, and are not
521 in the SVR4 ELF ABI. */
522
523 /* 32 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
524 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
525 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
526
527 /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
528 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
529 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
530
531 /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
532 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
533 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
534
535 /* The high order 16 bits of the addend minus the symbol. */
536 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
537 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
538
539 /* The high order 16 bits of the result of the addend minus the address,
540 plus 1 if the contents of the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number,
541 is negative. */
542 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
543 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
544
545 /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
546 address in the .sdata section, and returning the offset from
547 _SDA_BASE_ for that relocation. */
548 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
549 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
550
551 /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
552 address in the .sdata2 section, and returning the offset from
553 _SDA2_BASE_ for that relocation. */
554 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
555 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
556
557 /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA2_BASE_, for use with
558 small data items. */
559 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
560 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
561
562 /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling in the 16 bit
563 signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the register
564 field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13). */
565 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA21, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
566 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
567
568 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF */
569 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16 */
570 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO */
571 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI */
572 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA */
573 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD */
574
575 /* PC relative relocation against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling
576 in the 16 bit signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the
577 register field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13). */
578 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
579 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
580
581 /* A relative 8 bit branch. */
582 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL8, 1, 8, 0xff, 1, TRUE, signed,
583 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
584
585 /* A relative 15 bit branch. */
586 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL15, 2, 16, 0xfffe, 0, TRUE, signed,
587 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
588
589 /* A relative 24 bit branch. */
590 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL24, 2, 25, 0x1fffffe, 0, TRUE, signed,
591 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
592
593 /* The 16 LSBS in split16a format. */
594 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
595 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
596
597 /* The 16 LSBS in split16d format. */
598 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
599 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
600
601 /* Bits 16-31 split16a format. */
602 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
603 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
604
605 /* Bits 16-31 split16d format. */
606 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
607 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
608
609 /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16a format. */
610 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
611 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
612
613 /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16d format. */
614 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
615 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
616
617 /* This reloc is like R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 but only applies to e_add16i
618 instructions. If the register base is 0 then the linker changes
619 the e_add16i to an e_li instruction. */
620 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
621 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
622
623 /* Like R_PPC_VLE_SDA21 but ignore overflow. */
624 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
625 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
626
627 /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format. */
628 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
629 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
630
631 /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format. */
632 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
633 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
634
635 /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format. */
636 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
637 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
638
639 /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format. */
640 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
641 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
642
643 /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16a format. */
644 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
645 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
646
647 /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16d format. */
648 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
649 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
650
651 /* e_li split20 format. */
652 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20, 2, 20, 0x1f7fff, 0, FALSE, dont,
653 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
654
655 HOW (R_PPC_IRELATIVE, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
656 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
657
658 /* A 16 bit relative relocation. */
659 HOW (R_PPC_REL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, signed,
660 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
661
662 /* A 16 bit relative relocation without overflow. */
663 HOW (R_PPC_REL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, dont,
664 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
665
666 /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address. */
667 HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
668 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
669
670 /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address, plus 1 if the contents of
671 the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
672 HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
673 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
674
675 /* Like R_PPC_REL16_HA but for split field in addpcis. */
676 HOW (R_PPC_REL16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, TRUE, signed,
677 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
678
679 /* A split-field reloc for addpcis, non-relative (gas internal use only). */
680 HOW (R_PPC_16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, FALSE, signed,
681 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
682
683 /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable hierarchy. */
684 HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
685 NULL),
686
687 /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable member usage. */
688 HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
689 NULL),
690
691 /* Phony reloc to handle AIX style TOC entries. */
692 HOW (R_PPC_TOC16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
693 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
694 };
695 \f
696 /* Initialize the ppc_elf_howto_table, so that linear accesses can be done. */
697
698 static void
699 ppc_elf_howto_init (void)
700 {
701 unsigned int i, type;
702
703 for (i = 0;
704 i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
705 i++)
706 {
707 type = ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].type;
708 if (type >= (sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table)
709 / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table[0])))
710 abort ();
711 ppc_elf_howto_table[type] = &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
712 }
713 }
714
715 static reloc_howto_type *
716 ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
717 bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)
718 {
719 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r;
720
721 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
722 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
723 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
724
725 switch (code)
726 {
727 default:
728 return NULL;
729
730 case BFD_RELOC_NONE: r = R_PPC_NONE; break;
731 case BFD_RELOC_32: r = R_PPC_ADDR32; break;
732 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA26: r = R_PPC_ADDR24; break;
733 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
734 case BFD_RELOC_16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16; break;
735 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
736 case BFD_RELOC_LO16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_LO; break;
737 case BFD_RELOC_HI16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HI; break;
738 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HA; break;
739 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16: r = R_PPC_ADDR14; break;
740 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN; break;
741 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN; break;
742 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B26: r = R_PPC_REL24; break;
743 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16: r = R_PPC_REL14; break;
744 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN; break;
745 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN; break;
746 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
747 case BFD_RELOC_16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16; break;
748 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
749 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_LO; break;
750 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_HI; break;
751 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_HA; break;
752 case BFD_RELOC_24_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC_PLTREL24; break;
753 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_COPY: r = R_PPC_COPY; break;
754 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GLOB_DAT: r = R_PPC_GLOB_DAT; break;
755 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_LOCAL24PC: r = R_PPC_LOCAL24PC; break;
756 case BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL32; break;
757 case BFD_RELOC_32_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT32; break;
758 case BFD_RELOC_32_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC_PLTREL32; break;
759 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
760 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_LO; break;
761 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_HI; break;
762 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_HA; break;
763 case BFD_RELOC_GPREL16: r = R_PPC_SDAREL16; break;
764 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
765 case BFD_RELOC_16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF; break;
766 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
767 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO; break;
768 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI; break;
769 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA; break;
770 case BFD_RELOC_CTOR: r = R_PPC_ADDR32; break;
771 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
772 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TOC16: r = R_PPC_TOC16; break;
773 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLS: r = R_PPC_TLS; break;
774 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSGD: r = R_PPC_TLSGD; break;
775 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSLD: r = R_PPC_TLSLD; break;
776 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPMOD: r = R_PPC_DTPMOD32; break;
777 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
778 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16: r = R_PPC_TPREL16; break;
779 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
780 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO; break;
781 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HI; break;
782 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA; break;
783 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL: r = R_PPC_TPREL32; break;
784 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
785 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16; break;
786 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
787 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO; break;
788 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI; break;
789 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA; break;
790 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL: r = R_PPC_DTPREL32; break;
791 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16; break;
792 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO; break;
793 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI; break;
794 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA; break;
795 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16; break;
796 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO; break;
797 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI; break;
798 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA; break;
799 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16; break;
800 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO; break;
801 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI; break;
802 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA; break;
803 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16; break;
804 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO; break;
805 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI; break;
806 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA; break;
807 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR32: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32; break;
808 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16; break;
809 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO; break;
810 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI; break;
811 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA; break;
812 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDAI16: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16; break;
813 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16; break;
814 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL; break;
815 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA21: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA21; break;
816 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_MRKREF: r = R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF; break;
817 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16; break;
818 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO; break;
819 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI; break;
820 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA; break;
821 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD: r = R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD; break;
822 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSDA: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA; break;
823 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL8: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL8; break;
824 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL15: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL15; break;
825 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL24: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL24; break;
826 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16A; break;
827 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16D; break;
828 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16A; break;
829 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16D; break;
830 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16A; break;
831 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16D; break;
832 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21: r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21; break;
833 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO: r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO; break;
834 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
835 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A;
836 break;
837 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
838 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D;
839 break;
840 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
841 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A;
842 break;
843 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
844 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D;
845 break;
846 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
847 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A;
848 break;
849 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
850 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D;
851 break;
852 case BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16; break;
853 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_LO; break;
854 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_HI; break;
855 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_HA; break;
856 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_16DX_HA: r = R_PPC_16DX_HA; break;
857 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_REL16DX_HA: r = R_PPC_REL16DX_HA; break;
858 case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT: r = R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT; break;
859 case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY: r = R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY; break;
860 }
861
862 return ppc_elf_howto_table[r];
863 };
864
865 static reloc_howto_type *
866 ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
867 const char *r_name)
868 {
869 unsigned int i;
870
871 for (i = 0;
872 i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
873 i++)
874 if (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name != NULL
875 && strcasecmp (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name, r_name) == 0)
876 return &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
877
878 return NULL;
879 }
880
881 /* Set the howto pointer for a PowerPC ELF reloc. */
882
883 static bfd_boolean
884 ppc_elf_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd,
885 arelent *cache_ptr,
886 Elf_Internal_Rela *dst)
887 {
888 unsigned int r_type;
889
890 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
891 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
892 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
893
894 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info);
895 if (r_type >= R_PPC_max)
896 {
897 /* xgettext:c-format */
898 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
899 abfd, r_type);
900 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
901 return FALSE;
902 }
903
904 cache_ptr->howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
905
906 /* Just because the above assert didn't trigger doesn't mean that
907 ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info) is necessarily a valid relocation. */
908 if (cache_ptr->howto == NULL)
909 {
910 /* xgettext:c-format */
911 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
912 abfd, r_type);
913 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
914
915 return FALSE;
916 }
917
918 return TRUE;
919 }
920
921 /* Handle the R_PPC_ADDR16_HA and R_PPC_REL16_HA relocs. */
922
923 static bfd_reloc_status_type
924 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd,
925 arelent *reloc_entry,
926 asymbol *symbol,
927 void *data,
928 asection *input_section,
929 bfd *output_bfd,
930 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
931 {
932 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
933 long insn;
934 bfd_size_type octets;
935 bfd_vma value;
936
937 if (output_bfd != NULL)
938 {
939 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
940 return bfd_reloc_ok;
941 }
942
943 reloc_entry->addend += 0x8000;
944 r_type = reloc_entry->howto->type;
945 if (r_type != R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
946 return bfd_reloc_continue;
947
948 value = 0;
949 if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
950 value = symbol->value;
951 value += (reloc_entry->addend
952 + symbol->section->output_offset
953 + symbol->section->output_section->vma);
954 value -= (reloc_entry->address
955 + input_section->output_offset
956 + input_section->output_section->vma);
957 value >>= 16;
958
959 octets = reloc_entry->address * bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd);
960 insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
961 insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
962 insn |= (value & 0xffc1) | ((value & 0x3e) << 15);
963 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
964 return bfd_reloc_ok;
965 }
966
967 static bfd_reloc_status_type
968 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc (bfd *abfd,
969 arelent *reloc_entry,
970 asymbol *symbol,
971 void *data,
972 asection *input_section,
973 bfd *output_bfd,
974 char **error_message)
975 {
976 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
977 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
978 link time. */
979 if (output_bfd != NULL)
980 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
981 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
982
983 if (error_message != NULL)
984 {
985 static char buf[60];
986 sprintf (buf, _("generic linker can't handle %s"),
987 reloc_entry->howto->name);
988 *error_message = buf;
989 }
990 return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
991 }
992 \f
993 /* Sections created by the linker. */
994
995 typedef struct elf_linker_section
996 {
997 /* Pointer to the bfd section. */
998 asection *section;
999 /* Section name. */
1000 const char *name;
1001 /* Associated bss section name. */
1002 const char *bss_name;
1003 /* Associated symbol name. */
1004 const char *sym_name;
1005 /* Associated symbol. */
1006 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sym;
1007 } elf_linker_section_t;
1008
1009 /* Linked list of allocated pointer entries. This hangs off of the
1010 symbol lists, and provides allows us to return different pointers,
1011 based on different addend's. */
1012
1013 typedef struct elf_linker_section_pointers
1014 {
1015 /* next allocated pointer for this symbol */
1016 struct elf_linker_section_pointers *next;
1017 /* offset of pointer from beginning of section */
1018 bfd_vma offset;
1019 /* addend used */
1020 bfd_vma addend;
1021 /* which linker section this is */
1022 elf_linker_section_t *lsect;
1023 } elf_linker_section_pointers_t;
1024
1025 struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata
1026 {
1027 struct elf_obj_tdata elf;
1028
1029 /* A mapping from local symbols to offsets into the various linker
1030 sections added. This is index by the symbol index. */
1031 elf_linker_section_pointers_t **linker_section_pointers;
1032
1033 /* Flags used to auto-detect plt type. */
1034 unsigned int makes_plt_call : 1;
1035 unsigned int has_rel16 : 1;
1036 };
1037
1038 #define ppc_elf_tdata(bfd) \
1039 ((struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata *) (bfd)->tdata.any)
1040
1041 #define elf_local_ptr_offsets(bfd) \
1042 (ppc_elf_tdata (bfd)->linker_section_pointers)
1043
1044 #define is_ppc_elf(bfd) \
1045 (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
1046 && elf_object_id (bfd) == PPC32_ELF_DATA)
1047
1048 /* Override the generic function because we store some extras. */
1049
1050 static bfd_boolean
1051 ppc_elf_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
1052 {
1053 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata),
1054 PPC32_ELF_DATA);
1055 }
1056
1057 /* When defaulting arch/mach, decode apuinfo to find a better match. */
1058
1059 bfd_boolean
1060 _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (bfd *abfd)
1061 {
1062 unsigned long mach = 0;
1063 asection *s;
1064 unsigned char *contents;
1065
1066 if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32
1067 && bfd_big_endian (abfd))
1068 {
1069
1070 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
1071 if ((elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1072 break;
1073 if (s != NULL)
1074 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
1075 }
1076
1077 if (mach == 0)
1078 {
1079 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1080 if (s != NULL
1081 && s->size >= 24
1082 && bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &contents))
1083 {
1084 unsigned int apuinfo_size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + 4);
1085 unsigned int i;
1086
1087 for (i = 20; i < apuinfo_size + 20 && i + 4 <= s->size; i += 4)
1088 {
1089 unsigned int val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + i);
1090 switch (val >> 16)
1091 {
1092 case PPC_APUINFO_PMR:
1093 case PPC_APUINFO_RFMCI:
1094 if (mach == 0)
1095 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_titan;
1096 break;
1097
1098 case PPC_APUINFO_ISEL:
1099 case PPC_APUINFO_CACHELCK:
1100 if (mach == bfd_mach_ppc_titan)
1101 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500mc;
1102 break;
1103
1104 case PPC_APUINFO_SPE:
1105 case PPC_APUINFO_EFS:
1106 case PPC_APUINFO_BRLOCK:
1107 if (mach != bfd_mach_ppc_vle)
1108 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500;
1109 break;
1110
1111 case PPC_APUINFO_VLE:
1112 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
1113 break;
1114
1115 default:
1116 mach = -1ul;
1117 }
1118 }
1119 free (contents);
1120 }
1121 }
1122
1123 if (mach != 0 && mach != -1ul)
1124 {
1125 const bfd_arch_info_type *arch;
1126
1127 for (arch = abfd->arch_info->next; arch; arch = arch->next)
1128 if (arch->mach == mach)
1129 {
1130 abfd->arch_info = arch;
1131 break;
1132 }
1133 }
1134 return TRUE;
1135 }
1136
1137 /* Fix bad default arch selected for a 32 bit input bfd when the
1138 default is 64 bit. Also select arch based on apuinfo. */
1139
1140 static bfd_boolean
1141 ppc_elf_object_p (bfd *abfd)
1142 {
1143 if (!abfd->arch_info->the_default)
1144 return TRUE;
1145
1146 if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 64)
1147 {
1148 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
1149
1150 if (i_ehdr->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
1151 {
1152 /* Relies on arch after 64 bit default being 32 bit default. */
1153 abfd->arch_info = abfd->arch_info->next;
1154 BFD_ASSERT (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32);
1155 }
1156 }
1157 return _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (abfd);
1158 }
1159
1160 /* Function to set whether a module needs the -mrelocatable bit set. */
1161
1162 static bfd_boolean
1163 ppc_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
1164 {
1165 BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
1166 || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
1167
1168 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
1169 elf_flags_init (abfd) = TRUE;
1170 return TRUE;
1171 }
1172
1173 /* Support for core dump NOTE sections. */
1174
1175 static bfd_boolean
1176 ppc_elf_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1177 {
1178 int offset;
1179 unsigned int size;
1180
1181 switch (note->descsz)
1182 {
1183 default:
1184 return FALSE;
1185
1186 case 268: /* Linux/PPC. */
1187 /* pr_cursig */
1188 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_16 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
1189
1190 /* pr_pid */
1191 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 24);
1192
1193 /* pr_reg */
1194 offset = 72;
1195 size = 192;
1196
1197 break;
1198 }
1199
1200 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
1201 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
1202 size, note->descpos + offset);
1203 }
1204
1205 static bfd_boolean
1206 ppc_elf_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1207 {
1208 switch (note->descsz)
1209 {
1210 default:
1211 return FALSE;
1212
1213 case 128: /* Linux/PPC elf_prpsinfo. */
1214 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
1215 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 16);
1216 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
1217 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 32, 16);
1218 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
1219 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 48, 80);
1220 }
1221
1222 /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
1223 onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
1224 implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
1225
1226 {
1227 char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
1228 int n = strlen (command);
1229
1230 if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
1231 command[n - 1] = '\0';
1232 }
1233
1234 return TRUE;
1235 }
1236
1237 static char *
1238 ppc_elf_write_core_note (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz, int note_type, ...)
1239 {
1240 switch (note_type)
1241 {
1242 default:
1243 return NULL;
1244
1245 case NT_PRPSINFO:
1246 {
1247 char data[128] ATTRIBUTE_NONSTRING;
1248 va_list ap;
1249
1250 va_start (ap, note_type);
1251 memset (data, 0, sizeof (data));
1252 strncpy (data + 32, va_arg (ap, const char *), 16);
1253 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1254 DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH;
1255 /* GCC 8.0 and 8.1 warn about 80 equals destination size with
1256 -Wstringop-truncation:
1257 https://gcc.gnu.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=85643
1258 */
1259 DIAGNOSTIC_IGNORE_STRINGOP_TRUNCATION;
1260 #endif
1261 strncpy (data + 48, va_arg (ap, const char *), 80);
1262 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1263 DIAGNOSTIC_POP;
1264 #endif
1265 va_end (ap);
1266 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1267 "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1268 }
1269
1270 case NT_PRSTATUS:
1271 {
1272 char data[268];
1273 va_list ap;
1274 long pid;
1275 int cursig;
1276 const void *greg;
1277
1278 va_start (ap, note_type);
1279 memset (data, 0, 72);
1280 pid = va_arg (ap, long);
1281 bfd_put_32 (abfd, pid, data + 24);
1282 cursig = va_arg (ap, int);
1283 bfd_put_16 (abfd, cursig, data + 12);
1284 greg = va_arg (ap, const void *);
1285 memcpy (data + 72, greg, 192);
1286 memset (data + 264, 0, 4);
1287 va_end (ap);
1288 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1289 "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1290 }
1291 }
1292 }
1293
1294 static flagword
1295 ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags (char *flag_name)
1296 {
1297
1298 if (!strcmp (flag_name, "SHF_PPC_VLE"))
1299 return SHF_PPC_VLE;
1300
1301 return 0;
1302 }
1303
1304 /* Return address for Ith PLT stub in section PLT, for relocation REL
1305 or (bfd_vma) -1 if it should not be included. */
1306
1307 static bfd_vma
1308 ppc_elf_plt_sym_val (bfd_vma i ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1309 const asection *plt ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1310 const arelent *rel)
1311 {
1312 return rel->address;
1313 }
1314
1315 /* Handle a PowerPC specific section when reading an object file. This
1316 is called when bfd_section_from_shdr finds a section with an unknown
1317 type. */
1318
1319 static bfd_boolean
1320 ppc_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
1321 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
1322 const char *name,
1323 int shindex)
1324 {
1325 asection *newsect;
1326 flagword flags;
1327
1328 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
1329 return FALSE;
1330
1331 newsect = hdr->bfd_section;
1332 flags = bfd_section_flags (newsect);
1333 if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE)
1334 flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1335
1336 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_ORDERED)
1337 flags |= SEC_SORT_ENTRIES;
1338
1339 bfd_set_section_flags (newsect, flags);
1340 return TRUE;
1341 }
1342
1343 /* Set up any other section flags and such that may be necessary. */
1344
1345 static bfd_boolean
1346 ppc_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1347 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr,
1348 asection *asect)
1349 {
1350 if ((asect->flags & SEC_SORT_ENTRIES) != 0)
1351 shdr->sh_type = SHT_ORDERED;
1352
1353 return TRUE;
1354 }
1355
1356 /* If we have .sbss2 or .PPC.EMB.sbss0 output sections, we
1357 need to bump up the number of section headers. */
1358
1359 static int
1360 ppc_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd,
1361 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1362 {
1363 asection *s;
1364 int ret = 0;
1365
1366 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".sbss2");
1367 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1368 ++ret;
1369
1370 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0");
1371 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1372 ++ret;
1373
1374 return ret;
1375 }
1376
1377 /* Modify the segment map for VLE executables. */
1378
1379 bfd_boolean
1380 ppc_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
1381 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1382 {
1383 struct elf_segment_map *m;
1384
1385 /* At this point in the link, output sections have already been sorted by
1386 LMA and assigned to segments. All that is left to do is to ensure
1387 there is no mixing of VLE & non-VLE sections in a text segment.
1388 If we find that case, we split the segment.
1389 We maintain the original output section order. */
1390
1391 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
1392 {
1393 struct elf_segment_map *n;
1394 bfd_size_type amt;
1395 unsigned int j, k;
1396 unsigned int p_flags;
1397
1398 if (m->p_type != PT_LOAD || m->count == 0)
1399 continue;
1400
1401 for (p_flags = PF_R, j = 0; j != m->count; ++j)
1402 {
1403 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
1404 p_flags |= PF_W;
1405 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
1406 {
1407 p_flags |= PF_X;
1408 if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1409 p_flags |= PF_PPC_VLE;
1410 break;
1411 }
1412 }
1413 if (j != m->count)
1414 while (++j != m->count)
1415 {
1416 unsigned int p_flags1 = PF_R;
1417
1418 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
1419 p_flags1 |= PF_W;
1420 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
1421 {
1422 p_flags1 |= PF_X;
1423 if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1424 p_flags1 |= PF_PPC_VLE;
1425 if (((p_flags1 ^ p_flags) & PF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1426 break;
1427 }
1428 p_flags |= p_flags1;
1429 }
1430 /* If we're splitting a segment which originally contained rw
1431 sections then those sections might now only be in one of the
1432 two parts. So always set p_flags if splitting, even if we
1433 are being called for objcopy with p_flags_valid set. */
1434 if (j != m->count || !m->p_flags_valid)
1435 {
1436 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
1437 m->p_flags = p_flags;
1438 }
1439 if (j == m->count)
1440 continue;
1441
1442 /* Sections 0..j-1 stay in this (current) segment,
1443 the remainder are put in a new segment.
1444 The scan resumes with the new segment. */
1445
1446 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
1447 amt += (m->count - j - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
1448 n = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
1449 if (n == NULL)
1450 return FALSE;
1451
1452 n->p_type = PT_LOAD;
1453 n->count = m->count - j;
1454 for (k = 0; k < n->count; ++k)
1455 n->sections[k] = m->sections[j + k];
1456 m->count = j;
1457 m->p_size_valid = 0;
1458 n->next = m->next;
1459 m->next = n;
1460 }
1461
1462 return TRUE;
1463 }
1464
1465 /* Add extra PPC sections -- Note, for now, make .sbss2 and
1466 .PPC.EMB.sbss0 a normal section, and not a bss section so
1467 that the linker doesn't crater when trying to make more than
1468 2 sections. */
1469
1470 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_elf_special_sections[] =
1471 {
1472 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
1473 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1474 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1475 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1476 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1477 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tags"), 0, SHT_ORDERED, SHF_ALLOC },
1478 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (APUINFO_SECTION_NAME), 0, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
1479 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sbss0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1480 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sdata0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1481 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
1482 };
1483
1484 /* This is what we want for new plt/got. */
1485 static struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_alt_plt =
1486 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC };
1487
1488 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
1489 ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
1490 {
1491 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
1492
1493 /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
1494 if (sec->name == NULL)
1495 return NULL;
1496
1497 ssect = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, ppc_elf_special_sections,
1498 sec->use_rela_p);
1499 if (ssect != NULL)
1500 {
1501 if (ssect == ppc_elf_special_sections && (sec->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
1502 ssect = &ppc_alt_plt;
1503 return ssect;
1504 }
1505
1506 return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
1507 }
1508 \f
1509 /* Very simple linked list structure for recording apuinfo values. */
1510 typedef struct apuinfo_list
1511 {
1512 struct apuinfo_list *next;
1513 unsigned long value;
1514 }
1515 apuinfo_list;
1516
1517 static apuinfo_list *head;
1518 static bfd_boolean apuinfo_set;
1519
1520 static void
1521 apuinfo_list_init (void)
1522 {
1523 head = NULL;
1524 apuinfo_set = FALSE;
1525 }
1526
1527 static void
1528 apuinfo_list_add (unsigned long value)
1529 {
1530 apuinfo_list *entry = head;
1531
1532 while (entry != NULL)
1533 {
1534 if (entry->value == value)
1535 return;
1536 entry = entry->next;
1537 }
1538
1539 entry = bfd_malloc (sizeof (* entry));
1540 if (entry == NULL)
1541 return;
1542
1543 entry->value = value;
1544 entry->next = head;
1545 head = entry;
1546 }
1547
1548 static unsigned
1549 apuinfo_list_length (void)
1550 {
1551 apuinfo_list *entry;
1552 unsigned long count;
1553
1554 for (entry = head, count = 0;
1555 entry;
1556 entry = entry->next)
1557 ++ count;
1558
1559 return count;
1560 }
1561
1562 static inline unsigned long
1563 apuinfo_list_element (unsigned long number)
1564 {
1565 apuinfo_list * entry;
1566
1567 for (entry = head;
1568 entry && number --;
1569 entry = entry->next)
1570 ;
1571
1572 return entry ? entry->value : 0;
1573 }
1574
1575 static void
1576 apuinfo_list_finish (void)
1577 {
1578 apuinfo_list *entry;
1579
1580 for (entry = head; entry;)
1581 {
1582 apuinfo_list *next = entry->next;
1583 free (entry);
1584 entry = next;
1585 }
1586
1587 head = NULL;
1588 }
1589
1590 /* Scan the input BFDs and create a linked list of
1591 the APUinfo values that will need to be emitted. */
1592
1593 static void
1594 ppc_elf_begin_write_processing (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
1595 {
1596 bfd *ibfd;
1597 asection *asec;
1598 char *buffer = NULL;
1599 bfd_size_type largest_input_size = 0;
1600 unsigned i;
1601 unsigned long length;
1602 const char *error_message = NULL;
1603
1604 if (link_info == NULL)
1605 return;
1606
1607 apuinfo_list_init ();
1608
1609 /* Read in the input sections contents. */
1610 for (ibfd = link_info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
1611 {
1612 unsigned long datum;
1613
1614 asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1615 if (asec == NULL)
1616 continue;
1617
1618 /* xgettext:c-format */
1619 error_message = _("corrupt %s section in %pB");
1620 length = asec->size;
1621 if (length < 20)
1622 goto fail;
1623
1624 apuinfo_set = TRUE;
1625 if (largest_input_size < asec->size)
1626 {
1627 if (buffer)
1628 free (buffer);
1629 largest_input_size = asec->size;
1630 buffer = bfd_malloc (largest_input_size);
1631 if (!buffer)
1632 return;
1633 }
1634
1635 if (bfd_seek (ibfd, asec->filepos, SEEK_SET) != 0
1636 || (bfd_bread (buffer, length, ibfd) != length))
1637 {
1638 /* xgettext:c-format */
1639 error_message = _("unable to read in %s section from %pB");
1640 goto fail;
1641 }
1642
1643 /* Verify the contents of the header. Note - we have to
1644 extract the values this way in order to allow for a
1645 host whose endian-ness is different from the target. */
1646 datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer);
1647 if (datum != sizeof APUINFO_LABEL)
1648 goto fail;
1649
1650 datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 8);
1651 if (datum != 0x2)
1652 goto fail;
1653
1654 if (strcmp (buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL) != 0)
1655 goto fail;
1656
1657 /* Get the number of bytes used for apuinfo entries. */
1658 datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 4);
1659 if (datum + 20 != length)
1660 goto fail;
1661
1662 /* Scan the apuinfo section, building a list of apuinfo numbers. */
1663 for (i = 0; i < datum; i += 4)
1664 apuinfo_list_add (bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 20 + i));
1665 }
1666
1667 error_message = NULL;
1668
1669 if (apuinfo_set)
1670 {
1671 /* Compute the size of the output section. */
1672 unsigned num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
1673
1674 /* Set the output section size, if it exists. */
1675 asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1676
1677 if (asec && !bfd_set_section_size (asec, 20 + num_entries * 4))
1678 {
1679 ibfd = abfd;
1680 /* xgettext:c-format */
1681 error_message = _("warning: unable to set size of %s section in %pB");
1682 }
1683 }
1684
1685 fail:
1686 if (buffer)
1687 free (buffer);
1688
1689 if (error_message)
1690 _bfd_error_handler (error_message, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME, ibfd);
1691 }
1692
1693 /* Prevent the output section from accumulating the input sections'
1694 contents. We have already stored this in our linked list structure. */
1695
1696 static bfd_boolean
1697 ppc_elf_write_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1698 struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1699 asection *asec,
1700 bfd_byte *contents ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1701 {
1702 return apuinfo_set && strcmp (asec->name, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME) == 0;
1703 }
1704
1705 /* Finally we can generate the output section. */
1706
1707 static void
1708 ppc_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
1709 {
1710 bfd_byte *buffer;
1711 asection *asec;
1712 unsigned i;
1713 unsigned num_entries;
1714 bfd_size_type length;
1715
1716 asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1717 if (asec == NULL)
1718 return;
1719
1720 if (!apuinfo_set)
1721 return;
1722
1723 length = asec->size;
1724 if (length < 20)
1725 return;
1726
1727 buffer = bfd_malloc (length);
1728 if (buffer == NULL)
1729 {
1730 _bfd_error_handler
1731 (_("failed to allocate space for new APUinfo section"));
1732 return;
1733 }
1734
1735 /* Create the apuinfo header. */
1736 num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
1737 bfd_put_32 (abfd, sizeof APUINFO_LABEL, buffer);
1738 bfd_put_32 (abfd, num_entries * 4, buffer + 4);
1739 bfd_put_32 (abfd, 0x2, buffer + 8);
1740 strcpy ((char *) buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL);
1741
1742 length = 20;
1743 for (i = 0; i < num_entries; i++)
1744 {
1745 bfd_put_32 (abfd, apuinfo_list_element (i), buffer + length);
1746 length += 4;
1747 }
1748
1749 if (length != asec->size)
1750 _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to compute new APUinfo section"));
1751
1752 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, asec, buffer, (file_ptr) 0, length))
1753 _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to install new APUinfo section"));
1754
1755 free (buffer);
1756
1757 apuinfo_list_finish ();
1758 }
1759
1760 static bfd_boolean
1761 ppc_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
1762 {
1763 ppc_final_write_processing (abfd);
1764 return _bfd_elf_final_write_processing (abfd);
1765 }
1766 \f
1767 static bfd_boolean
1768 is_nonpic_glink_stub (bfd *abfd, asection *glink, bfd_vma off)
1769 {
1770 bfd_byte buf[4 * 4];
1771
1772 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf, off, sizeof buf))
1773 return FALSE;
1774
1775 return ((bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 0) & 0xffff0000) == LIS_11
1776 && (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 4) & 0xffff0000) == LWZ_11_11
1777 && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 8) == MTCTR_11
1778 && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 12) == BCTR);
1779 }
1780
1781 static bfd_boolean
1782 section_covers_vma (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section, void *ptr)
1783 {
1784 bfd_vma vma = *(bfd_vma *) ptr;
1785 return ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
1786 && section->vma <= vma
1787 && vma < section->vma + section->size);
1788 }
1789
1790 static long
1791 ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd, long symcount, asymbol **syms,
1792 long dynsymcount, asymbol **dynsyms,
1793 asymbol **ret)
1794 {
1795 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
1796 asection *plt, *relplt, *dynamic, *glink;
1797 bfd_vma glink_vma = 0;
1798 bfd_vma resolv_vma = 0;
1799 bfd_vma stub_off;
1800 asymbol *s;
1801 arelent *p;
1802 long count, i, stub_delta;
1803 size_t size;
1804 char *names;
1805 bfd_byte buf[4];
1806
1807 *ret = NULL;
1808
1809 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
1810 return 0;
1811
1812 if (dynsymcount <= 0)
1813 return 0;
1814
1815 relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.plt");
1816 if (relplt == NULL)
1817 return 0;
1818
1819 plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
1820 if (plt == NULL)
1821 return 0;
1822
1823 /* Call common code to handle old-style executable PLTs. */
1824 if (elf_section_flags (plt) & SHF_EXECINSTR)
1825 return _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (abfd, symcount, syms,
1826 dynsymcount, dynsyms, ret);
1827
1828 /* If this object was prelinked, the prelinker stored the address
1829 of .glink at got[1]. If it wasn't prelinked, got[1] will be zero. */
1830 dynamic = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1831 if (dynamic != NULL)
1832 {
1833 bfd_byte *dynbuf, *extdyn, *extdynend;
1834 size_t extdynsize;
1835 void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1836
1837 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, dynamic, &dynbuf))
1838 return -1;
1839
1840 extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1841 swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1842
1843 extdyn = dynbuf;
1844 extdynend = extdyn + dynamic->size;
1845 for (; extdyn < extdynend; extdyn += extdynsize)
1846 {
1847 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1848 (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1849
1850 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1851 break;
1852
1853 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_PPC_GOT)
1854 {
1855 unsigned int g_o_t = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1856 asection *got = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got");
1857 if (got != NULL
1858 && bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, got, buf,
1859 g_o_t - got->vma + 4, 4))
1860 glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1861 break;
1862 }
1863 }
1864 free (dynbuf);
1865 }
1866
1867 /* Otherwise we read the first plt entry. */
1868 if (glink_vma == 0)
1869 {
1870 if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, plt, buf, 0, 4))
1871 glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1872 }
1873
1874 if (glink_vma == 0)
1875 return 0;
1876
1877 /* The .glink section usually does not survive the final
1878 link; search for the section (usually .text) where the
1879 glink stubs now reside. */
1880 glink = bfd_sections_find_if (abfd, section_covers_vma, &glink_vma);
1881 if (glink == NULL)
1882 return 0;
1883
1884 /* Determine glink PLT resolver by reading the relative branch
1885 from the first glink stub. */
1886 if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
1887 glink_vma - glink->vma, 4))
1888 {
1889 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1890
1891 /* The first glink stub may either branch to the resolver ... */
1892 insn ^= B;
1893 if ((insn & ~0x3fffffc) == 0)
1894 resolv_vma = glink_vma + (insn ^ 0x2000000) - 0x2000000;
1895
1896 /* ... or fall through a bunch of NOPs. */
1897 else if ((insn ^ B ^ NOP) == 0)
1898 for (i = 4;
1899 bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
1900 glink_vma - glink->vma + i, 4);
1901 i += 4)
1902 if (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf) != NOP)
1903 {
1904 resolv_vma = glink_vma + i;
1905 break;
1906 }
1907 }
1908
1909 count = relplt->size / sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
1910 /* If the stubs are those for -shared/-pie then we might have
1911 multiple stubs for each plt entry. If that is the case then
1912 there is no way to associate stubs with their plt entries short
1913 of figuring out the GOT pointer value used in the stub.
1914 The offsets tested here need to cover all possible values of
1915 GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE for other than __tls_get_addr_opt. */
1916 stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1917 for (stub_delta = 16; stub_delta <= 32; stub_delta += 8)
1918 if (is_nonpic_glink_stub (abfd, glink, stub_off - stub_delta))
1919 break;
1920 if (stub_delta > 32)
1921 return 0;
1922
1923 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
1924 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
1925 return -1;
1926
1927 size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
1928 p = relplt->relocation;
1929 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p++)
1930 {
1931 size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
1932 if (p->addend != 0)
1933 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
1934 }
1935
1936 size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink");
1937
1938 if (resolv_vma)
1939 size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
1940
1941 s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
1942 if (s == NULL)
1943 return -1;
1944
1945 stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1946 names = (char *) (s + count + 1 + (resolv_vma != 0));
1947 p = relplt->relocation + count - 1;
1948 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
1949 {
1950 size_t len;
1951
1952 stub_off -= stub_delta;
1953 if (strcmp ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, "__tls_get_addr_opt") == 0)
1954 stub_off -= 32;
1955 *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
1956 /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
1957 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
1958 if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
1959 s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
1960 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1961 s->section = glink;
1962 s->value = stub_off;
1963 s->name = names;
1964 s->udata.p = NULL;
1965 len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
1966 memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
1967 names += len;
1968 if (p->addend != 0)
1969 {
1970 memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
1971 names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
1972 bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, names, p->addend);
1973 names += strlen (names);
1974 }
1975 memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
1976 names += sizeof ("@plt");
1977 ++s;
1978 --p;
1979 }
1980
1981 /* Add a symbol at the start of the glink branch table. */
1982 memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
1983 s->the_bfd = abfd;
1984 s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1985 s->section = glink;
1986 s->value = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1987 s->name = names;
1988 memcpy (names, "__glink", sizeof ("__glink"));
1989 names += sizeof ("__glink");
1990 s++;
1991 count++;
1992
1993 if (resolv_vma)
1994 {
1995 /* Add a symbol for the glink PLT resolver. */
1996 memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
1997 s->the_bfd = abfd;
1998 s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1999 s->section = glink;
2000 s->value = resolv_vma - glink->vma;
2001 s->name = names;
2002 memcpy (names, "__glink_PLTresolve", sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve"));
2003 names += sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
2004 s++;
2005 count++;
2006 }
2007
2008 return count;
2009 }
2010 \f
2011 /* The following functions are specific to the ELF linker, while
2012 functions above are used generally. They appear in this file more
2013 or less in the order in which they are called. eg.
2014 ppc_elf_check_relocs is called early in the link process,
2015 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections is one of the last functions
2016 called. */
2017
2018 /* Track PLT entries needed for a given symbol. We might need more
2019 than one glink entry per symbol when generating a pic binary. */
2020 struct plt_entry
2021 {
2022 struct plt_entry *next;
2023
2024 /* -fPIC uses multiple GOT sections, one per file, called ".got2".
2025 This field stores the offset into .got2 used to initialise the
2026 GOT pointer reg. It will always be at least 32768. (Current
2027 gcc always uses an offset of 32768, but ld -r will pack .got2
2028 sections together resulting in larger offsets). */
2029 bfd_vma addend;
2030
2031 /* The .got2 section. */
2032 asection *sec;
2033
2034 /* PLT refcount or offset. */
2035 union
2036 {
2037 bfd_signed_vma refcount;
2038 bfd_vma offset;
2039 } plt;
2040
2041 /* .glink stub offset. */
2042 bfd_vma glink_offset;
2043 };
2044
2045 /* Of those relocs that might be copied as dynamic relocs, this
2046 function selects those that must be copied when linking a shared
2047 library or PIE, even when the symbol is local. */
2048
2049 static int
2050 must_be_dyn_reloc (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2051 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2052 {
2053 switch (r_type)
2054 {
2055 default:
2056 /* Only relative relocs can be resolved when the object load
2057 address isn't fixed. DTPREL32 is excluded because the
2058 dynamic linker needs to differentiate global dynamic from
2059 local dynamic __tls_index pairs when PPC_OPT_TLS is set. */
2060 return 1;
2061
2062 case R_PPC_REL24:
2063 case R_PPC_REL14:
2064 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
2065 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
2066 case R_PPC_REL32:
2067 return 0;
2068
2069 case R_PPC_TPREL32:
2070 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
2071 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
2072 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
2073 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
2074 /* These relocations are relative but in a shared library the
2075 linker doesn't know the thread pointer base. */
2076 return bfd_link_dll (info);
2077 }
2078 }
2079
2080 /* If ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS is non-zero, the linker will try to avoid
2081 copying dynamic variables from a shared lib into an app's dynbss
2082 section, and instead use a dynamic relocation to point into the
2083 shared lib. */
2084 #define ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS 1
2085
2086 /* Used to track dynamic relocations for local symbols. */
2087 struct ppc_dyn_relocs
2088 {
2089 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *next;
2090
2091 /* The input section of the reloc. */
2092 asection *sec;
2093
2094 /* Total number of relocs copied for the input section. */
2095 unsigned int count : 31;
2096
2097 /* Whether this entry is for STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols. */
2098 unsigned int ifunc : 1;
2099 };
2100
2101 /* PPC ELF linker hash entry. */
2102
2103 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry
2104 {
2105 struct elf_link_hash_entry elf;
2106
2107 /* If this symbol is used in the linker created sections, the processor
2108 specific backend uses this field to map the field into the offset
2109 from the beginning of the section. */
2110 elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_pointer;
2111
2112 /* Track dynamic relocs copied for this symbol. */
2113 struct elf_dyn_relocs *dyn_relocs;
2114
2115 /* Contexts in which symbol is used in the GOT.
2116 Bits are or'd into the mask as the corresponding relocs are
2117 encountered during check_relocs, with TLS_TLS being set when any
2118 of the other TLS bits are set. tls_optimize clears bits when
2119 optimizing to indicate the corresponding GOT entry type is not
2120 needed. If set, TLS_TLS is never cleared. tls_optimize may also
2121 set TLS_GDIE when a GD reloc turns into an IE one.
2122 These flags are also kept for local symbols. */
2123 #define TLS_TLS 1 /* Any TLS reloc. */
2124 #define TLS_GD 2 /* GD reloc. */
2125 #define TLS_LD 4 /* LD reloc. */
2126 #define TLS_TPREL 8 /* TPREL reloc, => IE. */
2127 #define TLS_DTPREL 16 /* DTPREL reloc, => LD. */
2128 #define TLS_MARK 32 /* __tls_get_addr call marked. */
2129 #define TLS_GDIE 64 /* GOT TPREL reloc resulting from GD->IE. */
2130 unsigned char tls_mask;
2131
2132 /* The above field is also used to mark function symbols. In which
2133 case TLS_TLS will be 0. */
2134 #define PLT_IFUNC 2 /* STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
2135 #define PLT_KEEP 4 /* inline plt call requires plt entry. */
2136 #define NON_GOT 256 /* local symbol plt, not stored. */
2137
2138 /* Nonzero if we have seen a small data relocation referring to this
2139 symbol. */
2140 unsigned char has_sda_refs : 1;
2141
2142 /* Flag use of given relocations. */
2143 unsigned char has_addr16_ha : 1;
2144 unsigned char has_addr16_lo : 1;
2145 };
2146
2147 #define ppc_elf_hash_entry(ent) ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) (ent))
2148
2149 /* PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2150
2151 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table
2152 {
2153 struct elf_link_hash_table elf;
2154
2155 /* Various options passed from the linker. */
2156 struct ppc_elf_params *params;
2157
2158 /* Short-cuts to get to dynamic linker sections. */
2159 asection *glink;
2160 asection *dynsbss;
2161 asection *relsbss;
2162 elf_linker_section_t sdata[2];
2163 asection *sbss;
2164 asection *glink_eh_frame;
2165 asection *pltlocal;
2166 asection *relpltlocal;
2167
2168 /* The (unloaded but important) .rela.plt.unloaded on VxWorks. */
2169 asection *srelplt2;
2170
2171 /* Shortcut to __tls_get_addr. */
2172 struct elf_link_hash_entry *tls_get_addr;
2173
2174 /* The bfd that forced an old-style PLT. */
2175 bfd *old_bfd;
2176
2177 /* TLS local dynamic got entry handling. */
2178 union {
2179 bfd_signed_vma refcount;
2180 bfd_vma offset;
2181 } tlsld_got;
2182
2183 /* Offset of branch table to PltResolve function in glink. */
2184 bfd_vma glink_pltresolve;
2185
2186 /* Size of reserved GOT entries. */
2187 unsigned int got_header_size;
2188 /* Non-zero if allocating the header left a gap. */
2189 unsigned int got_gap;
2190
2191 /* The type of PLT we have chosen to use. */
2192 enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type;
2193
2194 /* True if the target system is VxWorks. */
2195 unsigned int is_vxworks:1;
2196
2197 /* Whether there exist local gnu indirect function resolvers,
2198 referenced by dynamic relocations. */
2199 unsigned int local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2200 unsigned int maybe_local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2201
2202 /* Set if tls optimization is enabled. */
2203 unsigned int do_tls_opt:1;
2204
2205 /* Set if inline plt calls should be converted to direct calls. */
2206 unsigned int can_convert_all_inline_plt:1;
2207
2208 /* The size of PLT entries. */
2209 int plt_entry_size;
2210 /* The distance between adjacent PLT slots. */
2211 int plt_slot_size;
2212 /* The size of the first PLT entry. */
2213 int plt_initial_entry_size;
2214
2215 /* Small local sym cache. */
2216 struct sym_cache sym_cache;
2217 };
2218
2219 /* Rename some of the generic section flags to better document how they
2220 are used for ppc32. The flags are only valid for ppc32 elf objects. */
2221
2222 /* Nonzero if this section has TLS related relocations. */
2223 #define has_tls_reloc sec_flg0
2224
2225 /* Nonzero if this section has a call to __tls_get_addr. */
2226 #define has_tls_get_addr_call sec_flg1
2227
2228 /* Flag set when PLTCALL relocs are detected. */
2229 #define has_pltcall sec_flg2
2230
2231 /* Get the PPC ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure. */
2232
2233 #define ppc_elf_hash_table(p) \
2234 (elf_hash_table_id ((struct elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) \
2235 == PPC32_ELF_DATA ? ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) : NULL)
2236
2237 /* Create an entry in a PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2238
2239 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
2240 ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
2241 struct bfd_hash_table *table,
2242 const char *string)
2243 {
2244 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
2245 subclass. */
2246 if (entry == NULL)
2247 {
2248 entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table,
2249 sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry));
2250 if (entry == NULL)
2251 return entry;
2252 }
2253
2254 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
2255 entry = _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
2256 if (entry != NULL)
2257 {
2258 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->linker_section_pointer = NULL;
2259 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
2260 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->tls_mask = 0;
2261 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->has_sda_refs = 0;
2262 }
2263
2264 return entry;
2265 }
2266
2267 /* Create a PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2268
2269 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
2270 ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
2271 {
2272 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
2273 static struct ppc_elf_params default_params
2274 = { PLT_OLD, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 12, 0, 0, 0 };
2275
2276 ret = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table));
2277 if (ret == NULL)
2278 return NULL;
2279
2280 if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->elf, abfd,
2281 ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc,
2282 sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry),
2283 PPC32_ELF_DATA))
2284 {
2285 free (ret);
2286 return NULL;
2287 }
2288
2289 ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.refcount = 0;
2290 ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.glist = NULL;
2291 ret->elf.init_plt_offset.offset = 0;
2292 ret->elf.init_plt_offset.glist = NULL;
2293
2294 ret->params = &default_params;
2295
2296 ret->sdata[0].name = ".sdata";
2297 ret->sdata[0].sym_name = "_SDA_BASE_";
2298 ret->sdata[0].bss_name = ".sbss";
2299
2300 ret->sdata[1].name = ".sdata2";
2301 ret->sdata[1].sym_name = "_SDA2_BASE_";
2302 ret->sdata[1].bss_name = ".sbss2";
2303
2304 ret->plt_entry_size = 12;
2305 ret->plt_slot_size = 8;
2306 ret->plt_initial_entry_size = 72;
2307
2308 return &ret->elf.root;
2309 }
2310
2311 /* Hook linker params into hash table. */
2312
2313 void
2314 ppc_elf_link_params (struct bfd_link_info *info, struct ppc_elf_params *params)
2315 {
2316 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2317
2318 if (htab)
2319 htab->params = params;
2320 params->pagesize_p2 = bfd_log2 (params->pagesize);
2321 }
2322
2323 /* Create .got and the related sections. */
2324
2325 static bfd_boolean
2326 ppc_elf_create_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2327 {
2328 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2329
2330 if (!_bfd_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info))
2331 return FALSE;
2332
2333 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2334 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
2335 {
2336 /* The powerpc .got has a blrl instruction in it. Mark it
2337 executable. */
2338 flagword flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2339 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2340 if (!bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.sgot, flags))
2341 return FALSE;
2342 }
2343
2344 return TRUE;
2345 }
2346
2347 /* Create a special linker section, used for R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16 and
2348 R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16 pointers. These sections become part of .sdata
2349 and .sdata2. Create _SDA_BASE_ and _SDA2_BASE too. */
2350
2351 static bfd_boolean
2352 ppc_elf_create_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
2353 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2354 flagword flags,
2355 elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
2356 {
2357 asection *s;
2358
2359 flags |= (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
2360 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2361
2362 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, lsect->name, flags);
2363 if (s == NULL)
2364 return FALSE;
2365 lsect->section = s;
2366
2367 /* Define the sym on the first section of this name. */
2368 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, lsect->name);
2369
2370 lsect->sym = _bfd_elf_define_linkage_sym (abfd, info, s, lsect->sym_name);
2371 if (lsect->sym == NULL)
2372 return FALSE;
2373 lsect->sym->root.u.def.value = 0x8000;
2374 return TRUE;
2375 }
2376
2377 static bfd_boolean
2378 ppc_elf_create_glink (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2379 {
2380 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2381 asection *s;
2382 flagword flags;
2383 int p2align;
2384
2385 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2386 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2387 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".glink", flags);
2388 htab->glink = s;
2389 p2align = htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 6 : 4;
2390 if (p2align < htab->params->plt_stub_align)
2391 p2align = htab->params->plt_stub_align;
2392 if (s == NULL
2393 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, p2align))
2394 return FALSE;
2395
2396 if (!info->no_ld_generated_unwind_info)
2397 {
2398 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2399 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2400 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".eh_frame", flags);
2401 htab->glink_eh_frame = s;
2402 if (s == NULL
2403 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2404 return FALSE;
2405 }
2406
2407 flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2408 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".iplt", flags);
2409 htab->elf.iplt = s;
2410 if (s == NULL
2411 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 4))
2412 return FALSE;
2413
2414 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2415 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2416 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.iplt", flags);
2417 htab->elf.irelplt = s;
2418 if (s == NULL
2419 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2420 return FALSE;
2421
2422 /* Local plt entries. */
2423 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
2424 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2425 htab->pltlocal = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".branch_lt",
2426 flags);
2427 if (htab->pltlocal == NULL
2428 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->pltlocal, 2))
2429 return FALSE;
2430
2431 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
2432 {
2433 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY
2434 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2435 htab->relpltlocal
2436 = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.branch_lt", flags);
2437 if (htab->relpltlocal == NULL
2438 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->relpltlocal, 2))
2439 return FALSE;
2440 }
2441
2442 if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, 0,
2443 &htab->sdata[0]))
2444 return FALSE;
2445
2446 if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, SEC_READONLY,
2447 &htab->sdata[1]))
2448 return FALSE;
2449
2450 return TRUE;
2451 }
2452
2453 /* We have to create .dynsbss and .rela.sbss here so that they get mapped
2454 to output sections (just like _bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections has
2455 to create .dynbss and .rela.bss). */
2456
2457 static bfd_boolean
2458 ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2459 {
2460 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2461 asection *s;
2462 flagword flags;
2463
2464 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2465
2466 if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL
2467 && !ppc_elf_create_got (abfd, info))
2468 return FALSE;
2469
2470 if (!_bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info))
2471 return FALSE;
2472
2473 if (htab->glink == NULL
2474 && !ppc_elf_create_glink (abfd, info))
2475 return FALSE;
2476
2477 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".dynsbss",
2478 SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2479 htab->dynsbss = s;
2480 if (s == NULL)
2481 return FALSE;
2482
2483 if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
2484 {
2485 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2486 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2487 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.sbss", flags);
2488 htab->relsbss = s;
2489 if (s == NULL
2490 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2491 return FALSE;
2492 }
2493
2494 if (htab->is_vxworks
2495 && !elf_vxworks_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info, &htab->srelplt2))
2496 return FALSE;
2497
2498 s = htab->elf.splt;
2499 flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2500 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
2501 /* The VxWorks PLT is a loaded section with contents. */
2502 flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY;
2503 return bfd_set_section_flags (s, flags);
2504 }
2505
2506 /* Copy the extra info we tack onto an elf_link_hash_entry. */
2507
2508 static void
2509 ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2510 struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
2511 struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
2512 {
2513 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *edir, *eind;
2514
2515 edir = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
2516 eind = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
2517
2518 edir->tls_mask |= eind->tls_mask;
2519 edir->has_sda_refs |= eind->has_sda_refs;
2520
2521 if (edir->elf.versioned != versioned_hidden)
2522 edir->elf.ref_dynamic |= eind->elf.ref_dynamic;
2523 edir->elf.ref_regular |= eind->elf.ref_regular;
2524 edir->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= eind->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
2525 edir->elf.non_got_ref |= eind->elf.non_got_ref;
2526 edir->elf.needs_plt |= eind->elf.needs_plt;
2527 edir->elf.pointer_equality_needed |= eind->elf.pointer_equality_needed;
2528
2529 /* If we were called to copy over info for a weak sym, that's all. */
2530 if (eind->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
2531 return;
2532
2533 if (eind->dyn_relocs != NULL)
2534 {
2535 if (edir->dyn_relocs != NULL)
2536 {
2537 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
2538 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
2539
2540 /* Add reloc counts against the indirect sym to the direct sym
2541 list. Merge any entries against the same section. */
2542 for (pp = &eind->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
2543 {
2544 struct elf_dyn_relocs *q;
2545
2546 for (q = edir->dyn_relocs; q != NULL; q = q->next)
2547 if (q->sec == p->sec)
2548 {
2549 q->pc_count += p->pc_count;
2550 q->count += p->count;
2551 *pp = p->next;
2552 break;
2553 }
2554 if (q == NULL)
2555 pp = &p->next;
2556 }
2557 *pp = edir->dyn_relocs;
2558 }
2559
2560 edir->dyn_relocs = eind->dyn_relocs;
2561 eind->dyn_relocs = NULL;
2562 }
2563
2564 /* Copy over the GOT refcount entries that we may have already seen to
2565 the symbol which just became indirect. */
2566 edir->elf.got.refcount += eind->elf.got.refcount;
2567 eind->elf.got.refcount = 0;
2568
2569 /* And plt entries. */
2570 if (eind->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
2571 {
2572 if (edir->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
2573 {
2574 struct plt_entry **entp;
2575 struct plt_entry *ent;
2576
2577 for (entp = &eind->elf.plt.plist; (ent = *entp) != NULL; )
2578 {
2579 struct plt_entry *dent;
2580
2581 for (dent = edir->elf.plt.plist; dent != NULL; dent = dent->next)
2582 if (dent->sec == ent->sec && dent->addend == ent->addend)
2583 {
2584 dent->plt.refcount += ent->plt.refcount;
2585 *entp = ent->next;
2586 break;
2587 }
2588 if (dent == NULL)
2589 entp = &ent->next;
2590 }
2591 *entp = edir->elf.plt.plist;
2592 }
2593
2594 edir->elf.plt.plist = eind->elf.plt.plist;
2595 eind->elf.plt.plist = NULL;
2596 }
2597
2598 if (eind->elf.dynindx != -1)
2599 {
2600 if (edir->elf.dynindx != -1)
2601 _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
2602 edir->elf.dynstr_index);
2603 edir->elf.dynindx = eind->elf.dynindx;
2604 edir->elf.dynstr_index = eind->elf.dynstr_index;
2605 eind->elf.dynindx = -1;
2606 eind->elf.dynstr_index = 0;
2607 }
2608 }
2609
2610 /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
2611 file. We use it to put .comm items in .sbss, and not .bss. */
2612
2613 static bfd_boolean
2614 ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
2615 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2616 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
2617 const char **namep ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2618 flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2619 asection **secp,
2620 bfd_vma *valp)
2621 {
2622 if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
2623 && !bfd_link_relocatable (info)
2624 && is_ppc_elf (info->output_bfd)
2625 && sym->st_size <= elf_gp_size (abfd))
2626 {
2627 /* Common symbols less than or equal to -G nn bytes are automatically
2628 put into .sbss. */
2629 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2630
2631 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2632 if (htab->sbss == NULL)
2633 {
2634 flagword flags = SEC_IS_COMMON | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2635
2636 if (!htab->elf.dynobj)
2637 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2638
2639 htab->sbss = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (htab->elf.dynobj,
2640 ".sbss",
2641 flags);
2642 if (htab->sbss == NULL)
2643 return FALSE;
2644 }
2645
2646 *secp = htab->sbss;
2647 *valp = sym->st_size;
2648 }
2649
2650 return TRUE;
2651 }
2652 \f
2653 /* Find a linker generated pointer with a given addend and type. */
2654
2655 static elf_linker_section_pointers_t *
2656 elf_find_pointer_linker_section
2657 (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_pointers,
2658 bfd_vma addend,
2659 elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
2660 {
2661 for ( ; linker_pointers != NULL; linker_pointers = linker_pointers->next)
2662 if (lsect == linker_pointers->lsect && addend == linker_pointers->addend)
2663 return linker_pointers;
2664
2665 return NULL;
2666 }
2667
2668 /* Allocate a pointer to live in a linker created section. */
2669
2670 static bfd_boolean
2671 elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
2672 elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
2673 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2674 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
2675 {
2676 elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr_linker_section_ptr = NULL;
2677 elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
2678 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2679 bfd_size_type amt;
2680
2681 BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
2682
2683 /* Is this a global symbol? */
2684 if (h != NULL)
2685 {
2686 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
2687
2688 /* Has this symbol already been allocated? If so, our work is done. */
2689 eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2690 if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (eh->linker_section_pointer,
2691 rel->r_addend,
2692 lsect))
2693 return TRUE;
2694
2695 ptr_linker_section_ptr = &eh->linker_section_pointer;
2696 }
2697 else
2698 {
2699 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
2700
2701 /* Allocation of a pointer to a local symbol. */
2702 elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd);
2703
2704 /* Allocate a table to hold the local symbols if first time. */
2705 if (!ptr)
2706 {
2707 unsigned int num_symbols = elf_symtab_hdr (abfd).sh_info;
2708
2709 amt = num_symbols;
2710 amt *= sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *);
2711 ptr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
2712
2713 if (!ptr)
2714 return FALSE;
2715
2716 elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd) = ptr;
2717 }
2718
2719 /* Has this symbol already been allocated? If so, our work is done. */
2720 if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (ptr[r_symndx],
2721 rel->r_addend,
2722 lsect))
2723 return TRUE;
2724
2725 ptr_linker_section_ptr = &ptr[r_symndx];
2726 }
2727
2728 /* Allocate space for a pointer in the linker section, and allocate
2729 a new pointer record from internal memory. */
2730 BFD_ASSERT (ptr_linker_section_ptr != NULL);
2731 amt = sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t);
2732 linker_section_ptr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2733
2734 if (!linker_section_ptr)
2735 return FALSE;
2736
2737 linker_section_ptr->next = *ptr_linker_section_ptr;
2738 linker_section_ptr->addend = rel->r_addend;
2739 linker_section_ptr->lsect = lsect;
2740 *ptr_linker_section_ptr = linker_section_ptr;
2741
2742 if (!bfd_set_section_alignment (lsect->section, 2))
2743 return FALSE;
2744 linker_section_ptr->offset = lsect->section->size;
2745 lsect->section->size += 4;
2746
2747 #ifdef DEBUG
2748 fprintf (stderr,
2749 "Create pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld, section size = %ld\n",
2750 lsect->name, (long) linker_section_ptr->offset,
2751 (long) lsect->section->size);
2752 #endif
2753
2754 return TRUE;
2755 }
2756
2757 static struct plt_entry **
2758 update_local_sym_info (bfd *abfd,
2759 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
2760 unsigned long r_symndx,
2761 int tls_type)
2762 {
2763 bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
2764 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
2765 unsigned char *local_got_tls_masks;
2766
2767 if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2768 {
2769 bfd_size_type size = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
2770
2771 size *= (sizeof (*local_got_refcounts)
2772 + sizeof (*local_plt)
2773 + sizeof (*local_got_tls_masks));
2774 local_got_refcounts = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size);
2775 if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2776 return NULL;
2777 elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) = local_got_refcounts;
2778 }
2779
2780 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_refcounts + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2781 local_got_tls_masks = (unsigned char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2782 local_got_tls_masks[r_symndx] |= tls_type & 0xff;
2783 if ((tls_type & NON_GOT) == 0)
2784 local_got_refcounts[r_symndx] += 1;
2785 return local_plt + r_symndx;
2786 }
2787
2788 static bfd_boolean
2789 update_plt_info (bfd *abfd, struct plt_entry **plist,
2790 asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
2791 {
2792 struct plt_entry *ent;
2793
2794 if (addend < 32768)
2795 sec = NULL;
2796 for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
2797 if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
2798 break;
2799 if (ent == NULL)
2800 {
2801 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*ent);
2802 ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2803 if (ent == NULL)
2804 return FALSE;
2805 ent->next = *plist;
2806 ent->sec = sec;
2807 ent->addend = addend;
2808 ent->plt.refcount = 0;
2809 *plist = ent;
2810 }
2811 ent->plt.refcount += 1;
2812 return TRUE;
2813 }
2814
2815 static struct plt_entry *
2816 find_plt_ent (struct plt_entry **plist, asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
2817 {
2818 struct plt_entry *ent;
2819
2820 if (addend < 32768)
2821 sec = NULL;
2822 for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
2823 if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
2824 break;
2825 return ent;
2826 }
2827
2828 static bfd_boolean
2829 is_branch_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2830 {
2831 return (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
2832 || r_type == R_PPC_LOCAL24PC
2833 || r_type == R_PPC_REL24
2834 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14
2835 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
2836 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN
2837 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR24
2838 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14
2839 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
2840 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN
2841 || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_REL24);
2842 }
2843
2844 /* Relocs on inline plt call sequence insns prior to the call. */
2845
2846 static bfd_boolean
2847 is_plt_seq_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2848 {
2849 return (r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA
2850 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2851 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2852 || r_type == R_PPC_PLTSEQ);
2853 }
2854
2855 static void
2856 bad_shared_reloc (bfd *abfd, enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2857 {
2858 _bfd_error_handler
2859 /* xgettext:c-format */
2860 (_("%pB: relocation %s cannot be used when making a shared object"),
2861 abfd,
2862 ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
2863 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2864 }
2865
2866 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
2867 allocate space in the global offset table or procedure linkage
2868 table. */
2869
2870 static bfd_boolean
2871 ppc_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd,
2872 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2873 asection *sec,
2874 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
2875 {
2876 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2877 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2878 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
2879 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
2880 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
2881 asection *got2, *sreloc;
2882 struct elf_link_hash_entry *tga;
2883
2884 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
2885 return TRUE;
2886
2887 /* Don't do anything special with non-loaded, non-alloced sections.
2888 In particular, any relocs in such sections should not affect GOT
2889 and PLT reference counting (ie. we don't allow them to create GOT
2890 or PLT entries), there's no possibility or desire to optimize TLS
2891 relocs, and there's not much point in propagating relocs to shared
2892 libs that the dynamic linker won't relocate. */
2893 if ((sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
2894 return TRUE;
2895
2896 #ifdef DEBUG
2897 _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_check_relocs called for section %pA in %pB",
2898 sec, abfd);
2899 #endif
2900
2901 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
2902
2903 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
2904 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
2905 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
2906
2907 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2908 if (htab->glink == NULL)
2909 {
2910 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2911 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2912 if (!ppc_elf_create_glink (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
2913 return FALSE;
2914 }
2915 tga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
2916 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
2917 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
2918 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
2919 got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
2920 sreloc = NULL;
2921
2922 rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
2923 for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
2924 {
2925 unsigned long r_symndx;
2926 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
2927 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
2928 int tls_type;
2929 struct plt_entry **ifunc;
2930 struct plt_entry **pltent;
2931 bfd_vma addend;
2932
2933 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2934 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
2935 h = NULL;
2936 else
2937 {
2938 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
2939 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
2940 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
2941 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
2942 }
2943
2944 /* If a relocation refers to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_, create the .got.
2945 This shows up in particular in an R_PPC_ADDR32 in the eabi
2946 startup code. */
2947 if (h != NULL
2948 && htab->elf.sgot == NULL
2949 && strcmp (h->root.root.string, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_") == 0)
2950 {
2951 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2952 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2953 if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
2954 return FALSE;
2955 BFD_ASSERT (h == htab->elf.hgot);
2956 }
2957
2958 tls_type = 0;
2959 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
2960 ifunc = NULL;
2961 if (h == NULL && !htab->is_vxworks)
2962 {
2963 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
2964 abfd, r_symndx);
2965 if (isym == NULL)
2966 return FALSE;
2967
2968 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
2969 {
2970 /* Set PLT_IFUNC flag for this sym, no GOT entry yet. */
2971 ifunc = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
2972 NON_GOT | PLT_IFUNC);
2973 if (ifunc == NULL)
2974 return FALSE;
2975
2976 /* STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols must have a PLT entry;
2977 In a non-pie executable even when there are
2978 no plt calls. */
2979 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
2980 || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
2981 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2982 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2983 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA)
2984 {
2985 addend = 0;
2986 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
2987 ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
2988 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
2989 && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
2990 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2991 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2992 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
2993 addend = rel->r_addend;
2994 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, ifunc, got2, addend))
2995 return FALSE;
2996 }
2997 }
2998 }
2999
3000 if (!htab->is_vxworks
3001 && is_branch_reloc (r_type)
3002 && h != NULL
3003 && h == tga)
3004 {
3005 if (rel != relocs
3006 && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSGD
3007 || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSLD))
3008 /* We have a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a marker
3009 reloc. */
3010 ;
3011 else
3012 /* Mark this section as having an old-style call. */
3013 sec->has_tls_get_addr_call = 1;
3014 }
3015
3016 switch (r_type)
3017 {
3018 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
3019 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
3020 /* These special tls relocs tie a call to __tls_get_addr with
3021 its parameter symbol. */
3022 if (h != NULL)
3023 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK;
3024 else
3025 if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
3026 NON_GOT | TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
3027 return FALSE;
3028 break;
3029
3030 case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
3031 break;
3032
3033 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
3034 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
3035 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
3036 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
3037 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
3038 goto dogottls;
3039
3040 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
3041 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
3042 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
3043 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
3044 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
3045 goto dogottls;
3046
3047 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
3048 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
3049 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
3050 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
3051 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
3052 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
3053 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
3054 goto dogottls;
3055
3056 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
3057 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
3058 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
3059 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
3060 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
3061 dogottls:
3062 sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
3063 /* Fall through. */
3064
3065 /* GOT16 relocations */
3066 case R_PPC_GOT16:
3067 case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
3068 case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
3069 case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
3070 /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry. */
3071 if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
3072 {
3073 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
3074 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
3075 if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
3076 return FALSE;
3077 }
3078 if (h != NULL)
3079 {
3080 h->got.refcount += 1;
3081 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= tls_type;
3082 }
3083 else
3084 /* This is a global offset table entry for a local symbol. */
3085 if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx, tls_type))
3086 return FALSE;
3087
3088 /* We may also need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3089 an ifunc. */
3090 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3091 {
3092 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3093 return FALSE;
3094 }
3095 break;
3096
3097 /* Indirect .sdata relocation. */
3098 case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
3099 htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3100 if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[0],
3101 h, rel))
3102 return FALSE;
3103 if (h != NULL)
3104 {
3105 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3106 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3107 }
3108 break;
3109
3110 /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation. */
3111 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
3112 if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
3113 {
3114 bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3115 return FALSE;
3116 }
3117 htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3118 if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[1],
3119 h, rel))
3120 return FALSE;
3121 if (h != NULL)
3122 {
3123 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3124 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3125 }
3126 break;
3127
3128 case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
3129 htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3130 /* Fall through. */
3131
3132 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
3133 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
3134 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
3135 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
3136 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
3137 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
3138 if (h != NULL)
3139 {
3140 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3141 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3142 }
3143 break;
3144
3145 case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
3146 case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
3147 case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
3148 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
3149 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
3150 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
3151 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
3152 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
3153 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
3154 case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
3155 break;
3156
3157 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
3158 if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
3159 {
3160 bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3161 return FALSE;
3162 }
3163 htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3164 if (h != NULL)
3165 {
3166 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3167 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3168 }
3169 break;
3170
3171 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
3172 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
3173 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
3174 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
3175 if (h != NULL)
3176 {
3177 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3178 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3179 }
3180 break;
3181
3182 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
3183 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
3184 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
3185 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
3186 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
3187 if (h != NULL)
3188 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3189 break;
3190
3191 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
3192 if (h == NULL)
3193 break;
3194 ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
3195 goto pltentry;
3196
3197 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
3198 sec->has_pltcall = 1;
3199 /* Fall through. */
3200
3201 case R_PPC_PLT32:
3202 case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
3203 case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
3204 case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
3205 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
3206 pltentry:
3207 #ifdef DEBUG
3208 fprintf (stderr, "Reloc requires a PLT entry\n");
3209 #endif
3210 /* This symbol requires a procedure linkage table entry. */
3211 if (h == NULL)
3212 {
3213 pltent = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
3214 NON_GOT | PLT_KEEP);
3215 if (pltent == NULL)
3216 return FALSE;
3217 }
3218 else
3219 {
3220 if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
3221 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= PLT_KEEP;
3222 h->needs_plt = 1;
3223 pltent = &h->plt.plist;
3224 }
3225 addend = 0;
3226 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3227 && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
3228 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
3229 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
3230 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
3231 addend = rel->r_addend;
3232 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, pltent, got2, addend))
3233 return FALSE;
3234 break;
3235
3236 /* The following relocations don't need to propagate the
3237 relocation if linking a shared object since they are
3238 section relative. */
3239 case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
3240 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
3241 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
3242 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
3243 case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
3244 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
3245 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
3246 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
3247 case R_PPC_TOC16:
3248 break;
3249
3250 case R_PPC_REL16:
3251 case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
3252 case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
3253 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
3254 case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
3255 ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_rel16 = 1;
3256 break;
3257
3258 /* These are just markers. */
3259 case R_PPC_TLS:
3260 case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
3261 case R_PPC_NONE:
3262 case R_PPC_max:
3263 case R_PPC_RELAX:
3264 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
3265 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
3266 case R_PPC_16DX_HA:
3267 break;
3268
3269 /* These should only appear in dynamic objects. */
3270 case R_PPC_COPY:
3271 case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
3272 case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
3273 case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
3274 case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
3275 break;
3276
3277 /* These aren't handled yet. We'll report an error later. */
3278 case R_PPC_ADDR30:
3279 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
3280 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
3281 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
3282 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
3283 case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
3284 break;
3285
3286 /* This refers only to functions defined in the shared library. */
3287 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
3288 if (h != NULL && h == htab->elf.hgot && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3289 {
3290 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3291 htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3292 }
3293 if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
3294 {
3295 h->needs_plt = 1;
3296 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3297 return FALSE;
3298 }
3299 break;
3300
3301 /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
3302 Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */
3303 case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
3304 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
3305 return FALSE;
3306 break;
3307
3308 /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
3309 used. Record for later use during GC. */
3310 case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
3311 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_addend))
3312 return FALSE;
3313 break;
3314
3315 /* We shouldn't really be seeing TPREL32. */
3316 case R_PPC_TPREL32:
3317 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
3318 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
3319 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
3320 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
3321 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
3322 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
3323 goto dodyn;
3324
3325 /* Nor these. */
3326 case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
3327 case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
3328 goto dodyn;
3329
3330 case R_PPC_REL32:
3331 if (h == NULL
3332 && got2 != NULL
3333 && (sec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
3334 && bfd_link_pic (info)
3335 && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3336 {
3337 /* Old -fPIC gcc code has .long LCTOC1-LCFx just before
3338 the start of a function, which assembles to a REL32
3339 reference to .got2. If we detect one of these, then
3340 force the old PLT layout because the linker cannot
3341 reliably deduce the GOT pointer value needed for
3342 PLT call stubs. */
3343 asection *s;
3344 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
3345
3346 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
3347 abfd, r_symndx);
3348 if (isym == NULL)
3349 return FALSE;
3350
3351 s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
3352 if (s == got2)
3353 {
3354 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3355 htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3356 }
3357 }
3358 if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
3359 break;
3360 /* fall through */
3361
3362 case R_PPC_ADDR32:
3363 case R_PPC_ADDR16:
3364 case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
3365 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
3366 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
3367 case R_PPC_UADDR32:
3368 case R_PPC_UADDR16:
3369 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3370 {
3371 /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3372 a function defined in a dynamic object. */
3373 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3374 return FALSE;
3375
3376 /* We may need a copy reloc too. */
3377 h->non_got_ref = 1;
3378 h->pointer_equality_needed = 1;
3379 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
3380 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha = 1;
3381 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
3382 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo = 1;
3383 }
3384 goto dodyn;
3385
3386 case R_PPC_REL24:
3387 case R_PPC_REL14:
3388 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
3389 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
3390 if (h == NULL)
3391 break;
3392 if (h == htab->elf.hgot)
3393 {
3394 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3395 {
3396 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3397 htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3398 }
3399 break;
3400 }
3401 /* fall through */
3402
3403 case R_PPC_ADDR24:
3404 case R_PPC_ADDR14:
3405 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
3406 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
3407 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3408 {
3409 /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3410 a function defined in a dynamic object. */
3411 h->needs_plt = 1;
3412 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3413 return FALSE;
3414 break;
3415 }
3416
3417 dodyn:
3418 /* If we are creating a shared library, and this is a reloc
3419 against a global symbol, or a non PC relative reloc
3420 against a local symbol, then we need to copy the reloc
3421 into the shared library. However, if we are linking with
3422 -Bsymbolic, we do not need to copy a reloc against a
3423 global symbol which is defined in an object we are
3424 including in the link (i.e., DEF_REGULAR is set). At
3425 this point we have not seen all the input files, so it is
3426 possible that DEF_REGULAR is not set now but will be set
3427 later (it is never cleared). In case of a weak definition,
3428 DEF_REGULAR may be cleared later by a strong definition in
3429 a shared library. We account for that possibility below by
3430 storing information in the dyn_relocs field of the hash
3431 table entry. A similar situation occurs when creating
3432 shared libraries and symbol visibility changes render the
3433 symbol local.
3434
3435 If on the other hand, we are creating an executable, we
3436 may need to keep relocations for symbols satisfied by a
3437 dynamic library if we manage to avoid copy relocs for the
3438 symbol. */
3439 if ((bfd_link_pic (info)
3440 && (must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)
3441 || (h != NULL
3442 && (!SYMBOLIC_BIND (info, h)
3443 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
3444 || !h->def_regular))))
3445 || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
3446 && !bfd_link_pic (info)
3447 && h != NULL
3448 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
3449 || !h->def_regular)))
3450 {
3451 #ifdef DEBUG
3452 fprintf (stderr,
3453 "ppc_elf_check_relocs needs to "
3454 "create relocation for %s\n",
3455 (h && h->root.root.string
3456 ? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
3457 #endif
3458 if (sreloc == NULL)
3459 {
3460 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
3461 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
3462
3463 sreloc = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_reloc_section
3464 (sec, htab->elf.dynobj, 2, abfd, /*rela?*/ TRUE);
3465
3466 if (sreloc == NULL)
3467 return FALSE;
3468 }
3469
3470 /* If this is a global symbol, we count the number of
3471 relocations we need for this symbol. */
3472 if (h != NULL)
3473 {
3474 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
3475 struct elf_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
3476
3477 rel_head = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs;
3478 p = *rel_head;
3479 if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec)
3480 {
3481 p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
3482 if (p == NULL)
3483 return FALSE;
3484 p->next = *rel_head;
3485 *rel_head = p;
3486 p->sec = sec;
3487 p->count = 0;
3488 p->pc_count = 0;
3489 }
3490 p->count += 1;
3491 if (!must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
3492 p->pc_count += 1;
3493 }
3494 else
3495 {
3496 /* Track dynamic relocs needed for local syms too.
3497 We really need local syms available to do this
3498 easily. Oh well. */
3499 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
3500 struct ppc_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
3501 bfd_boolean is_ifunc;
3502 asection *s;
3503 void *vpp;
3504 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
3505
3506 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
3507 abfd, r_symndx);
3508 if (isym == NULL)
3509 return FALSE;
3510
3511 s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
3512 if (s == NULL)
3513 s = sec;
3514
3515 vpp = &elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel;
3516 rel_head = (struct ppc_dyn_relocs **) vpp;
3517 is_ifunc = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC;
3518 p = *rel_head;
3519 if (p != NULL && p->sec == sec && p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
3520 p = p->next;
3521 if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec || p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
3522 {
3523 p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
3524 if (p == NULL)
3525 return FALSE;
3526 p->next = *rel_head;
3527 *rel_head = p;
3528 p->sec = sec;
3529 p->ifunc = is_ifunc;
3530 p->count = 0;
3531 }
3532 p->count += 1;
3533 }
3534 }
3535
3536 break;
3537 }
3538 }
3539
3540 return TRUE;
3541 }
3542 \f
3543 /* Warn for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP attributes between IBFD
3544 and OBFD, and merge non-conflicting ones. */
3545 bfd_boolean
3546 _bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3547 {
3548 bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3549 obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
3550 obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
3551 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
3552
3553 in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3554 out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3555
3556 in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
3557 out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
3558
3559 if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3560 {
3561 int in_fp = in_attr->i & 3;
3562 int out_fp = out_attr->i & 3;
3563 static bfd *last_fp, *last_ld;
3564
3565 if (in_fp == 0)
3566 ;
3567 else if (out_fp == 0)
3568 {
3569 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3570 out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
3571 last_fp = ibfd;
3572 }
3573 else if (out_fp != 2 && in_fp == 2)
3574 {
3575 _bfd_error_handler
3576 /* xgettext:c-format */
3577 (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
3578 last_fp, ibfd);
3579 ret = FALSE;
3580 }
3581 else if (out_fp == 2 && in_fp != 2)
3582 {
3583 _bfd_error_handler
3584 /* xgettext:c-format */
3585 (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
3586 ibfd, last_fp);
3587 ret = FALSE;
3588 }
3589 else if (out_fp == 1 && in_fp == 3)
3590 {
3591 _bfd_error_handler
3592 /* xgettext:c-format */
3593 (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
3594 "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), last_fp, ibfd);
3595 ret = FALSE;
3596 }
3597 else if (out_fp == 3 && in_fp == 1)
3598 {
3599 _bfd_error_handler
3600 /* xgettext:c-format */
3601 (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
3602 "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), ibfd, last_fp);
3603 ret = FALSE;
3604 }
3605
3606 in_fp = in_attr->i & 0xc;
3607 out_fp = out_attr->i & 0xc;
3608 if (in_fp == 0)
3609 ;
3610 else if (out_fp == 0)
3611 {
3612 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3613 out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
3614 last_ld = ibfd;
3615 }
3616 else if (out_fp != 2 * 4 && in_fp == 2 * 4)
3617 {
3618 _bfd_error_handler
3619 /* xgettext:c-format */
3620 (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
3621 "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
3622 ret = FALSE;
3623 }
3624 else if (in_fp != 2 * 4 && out_fp == 2 * 4)
3625 {
3626 _bfd_error_handler
3627 /* xgettext:c-format */
3628 (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
3629 "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
3630 ret = FALSE;
3631 }
3632 else if (out_fp == 1 * 4 && in_fp == 3 * 4)
3633 {
3634 _bfd_error_handler
3635 /* xgettext:c-format */
3636 (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
3637 "%pB uses IEEE long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
3638 ret = FALSE;
3639 }
3640 else if (out_fp == 3 * 4 && in_fp == 1 * 4)
3641 {
3642 _bfd_error_handler
3643 /* xgettext:c-format */
3644 (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
3645 "%pB uses IEEE long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
3646 ret = FALSE;
3647 }
3648 }
3649
3650 if (!ret)
3651 {
3652 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3653 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3654 }
3655 return ret;
3656 }
3657
3658 /* Merge object attributes from IBFD into OBFD. Warn if
3659 there are conflicting attributes. */
3660 static bfd_boolean
3661 ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3662 {
3663 bfd *obfd;
3664 obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
3665 obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
3666 bfd_boolean ret;
3667
3668 if (!_bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (ibfd, info))
3669 return FALSE;
3670
3671 obfd = info->output_bfd;
3672 in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3673 out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3674
3675 /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector attributes and
3676 merge non-conflicting ones. */
3677 in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
3678 out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
3679 ret = TRUE;
3680 if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3681 {
3682 int in_vec = in_attr->i & 3;
3683 int out_vec = out_attr->i & 3;
3684 static bfd *last_vec;
3685
3686 if (in_vec == 0)
3687 ;
3688 else if (out_vec == 0)
3689 {
3690 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3691 out_attr->i = in_vec;
3692 last_vec = ibfd;
3693 }
3694 /* For now, allow generic to transition to AltiVec or SPE
3695 without a warning. If GCC marked files with their stack
3696 alignment and used don't-care markings for files which are
3697 not affected by the vector ABI, we could warn about this
3698 case too. */
3699 else if (in_vec == 1)
3700 ;
3701 else if (out_vec == 1)
3702 {
3703 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3704 out_attr->i = in_vec;
3705 last_vec = ibfd;
3706 }
3707 else if (out_vec < in_vec)
3708 {
3709 _bfd_error_handler
3710 /* xgettext:c-format */
3711 (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
3712 last_vec, ibfd);
3713 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3714 ret = FALSE;
3715 }
3716 else if (out_vec > in_vec)
3717 {
3718 _bfd_error_handler
3719 /* xgettext:c-format */
3720 (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
3721 ibfd, last_vec);
3722 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3723 ret = FALSE;
3724 }
3725 }
3726
3727 /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return attributes
3728 and merge non-conflicting ones. */
3729 in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
3730 out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
3731 if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3732 {
3733 int in_struct = in_attr->i & 3;
3734 int out_struct = out_attr->i & 3;
3735 static bfd *last_struct;
3736
3737 if (in_struct == 0 || in_struct == 3)
3738 ;
3739 else if (out_struct == 0)
3740 {
3741 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3742 out_attr->i = in_struct;
3743 last_struct = ibfd;
3744 }
3745 else if (out_struct < in_struct)
3746 {
3747 _bfd_error_handler
3748 /* xgettext:c-format */
3749 (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
3750 "%pB uses memory"), last_struct, ibfd);
3751 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3752 ret = FALSE;
3753 }
3754 else if (out_struct > in_struct)
3755 {
3756 _bfd_error_handler
3757 /* xgettext:c-format */
3758 (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
3759 "%pB uses memory"), ibfd, last_struct);
3760 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3761 ret = FALSE;
3762 }
3763 }
3764 if (!ret)
3765 {
3766 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3767 return FALSE;
3768 }
3769
3770 /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones. */
3771 return _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, info);
3772 }
3773
3774 /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
3775 object file when linking. */
3776
3777 static bfd_boolean
3778 ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3779 {
3780 bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3781 flagword old_flags;
3782 flagword new_flags;
3783 bfd_boolean error;
3784
3785 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd) || !is_ppc_elf (obfd))
3786 return TRUE;
3787
3788 /* Check if we have the same endianness. */
3789 if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, info))
3790 return FALSE;
3791
3792 if (!ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (ibfd, info))
3793 return FALSE;
3794
3795 new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
3796 old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
3797 if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
3798 {
3799 /* First call, no flags set. */
3800 elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
3801 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags;
3802 }
3803
3804 /* Compatible flags are ok. */
3805 else if (new_flags == old_flags)
3806 ;
3807
3808 /* Incompatible flags. */
3809 else
3810 {
3811 /* Warn about -mrelocatable mismatch. Allow -mrelocatable-lib
3812 to be linked with either. */
3813 error = FALSE;
3814 if ((new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0
3815 && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0)
3816 {
3817 error = TRUE;
3818 _bfd_error_handler
3819 (_("%pB: compiled with -mrelocatable and linked with "
3820 "modules compiled normally"), ibfd);
3821 }
3822 else if ((new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0
3823 && (old_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0)
3824 {
3825 error = TRUE;
3826 _bfd_error_handler
3827 (_("%pB: compiled normally and linked with "
3828 "modules compiled with -mrelocatable"), ibfd);
3829 }
3830
3831 /* The output is -mrelocatable-lib iff both the input files are. */
3832 if (! (new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB))
3833 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB;
3834
3835 /* The output is -mrelocatable iff it can't be -mrelocatable-lib,
3836 but each input file is either -mrelocatable or -mrelocatable-lib. */
3837 if (! (elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)
3838 && (new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE))
3839 && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE)))
3840 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE;
3841
3842 /* Do not warn about eabi vs. V.4 mismatch, just or in the bit if
3843 any module uses it. */
3844 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= (new_flags & EF_PPC_EMB);
3845
3846 new_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
3847 old_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
3848
3849 /* Warn about any other mismatches. */
3850 if (new_flags != old_flags)
3851 {
3852 error = TRUE;
3853 _bfd_error_handler
3854 /* xgettext:c-format */
3855 (_("%pB: uses different e_flags (%#x) fields "
3856 "than previous modules (%#x)"),
3857 ibfd, new_flags, old_flags);
3858 }
3859
3860 if (error)
3861 {
3862 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3863 return FALSE;
3864 }
3865 }
3866
3867 return TRUE;
3868 }
3869
3870 static void
3871 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (bfd *input_bfd,
3872 asection *input_section,
3873 unsigned long offset,
3874 bfd_byte *loc,
3875 bfd_vma value,
3876 split16_format_type split16_format,
3877 bfd_boolean fixup)
3878 {
3879 unsigned int insn, opcode;
3880
3881 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, loc);
3882 opcode = insn & E_OPCODE_MASK;
3883 if (opcode == E_OR2I_INSN
3884 || opcode == E_AND2I_DOT_INSN
3885 || opcode == E_OR2IS_INSN
3886 || opcode == E_LIS_INSN
3887 || opcode == E_AND2IS_DOT_INSN)
3888 {
3889 if (split16_format != split16a_type)
3890 {
3891 if (fixup)
3892 split16_format = split16a_type;
3893 else
3894 _bfd_error_handler
3895 /* xgettext:c-format */
3896 (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16A style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
3897 input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
3898 }
3899 }
3900 else if (opcode == E_ADD2I_DOT_INSN
3901 || opcode == E_ADD2IS_INSN
3902 || opcode == E_CMP16I_INSN
3903 || opcode == E_MULL2I_INSN
3904 || opcode == E_CMPL16I_INSN
3905 || opcode == E_CMPH16I_INSN
3906 || opcode == E_CMPHL16I_INSN)
3907 {
3908 if (split16_format != split16d_type)
3909 {
3910 if (fixup)
3911 split16_format = split16d_type;
3912 else
3913 _bfd_error_handler
3914 /* xgettext:c-format */
3915 (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16D style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
3916 input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
3917 }
3918 }
3919 if (split16_format == split16a_type)
3920 {
3921 insn &= ~((0xf800 << 5) | 0x7ff);
3922 insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
3923 if ((insn & E_LI_MASK) == E_LI_INSN)
3924 {
3925 /* Hack for e_li. Extend sign. */
3926 insn &= ~(0xf0000 >> 5);
3927 insn |= (-(value & 0x8000) & 0xf0000) >> 5;
3928 }
3929 }
3930 else
3931 {
3932 insn &= ~((0xf800 << 10) | 0x7ff);
3933 insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 10;
3934 }
3935 insn |= value & 0x7ff;
3936 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, loc);
3937 }
3938
3939 static void
3940 ppc_elf_vle_split20 (bfd *output_bfd, bfd_byte *loc, bfd_vma value)
3941 {
3942 unsigned int insn;
3943
3944 insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
3945 /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31. */
3946 /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20. */
3947 insn |= (value & 0xf0000) >> 5;
3948 /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15. */
3949 insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
3950 /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31. */
3951 insn |= value & 0x7ff;
3952 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, insn, loc);
3953 }
3954
3955 \f
3956 /* Choose which PLT scheme to use, and set .plt flags appropriately.
3957 Returns -1 on error, 0 for old PLT, 1 for new PLT. */
3958 int
3959 ppc_elf_select_plt_layout (bfd *output_bfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3960 struct bfd_link_info *info)
3961 {
3962 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3963 flagword flags;
3964
3965 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
3966
3967 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3968 {
3969 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3970
3971 if (htab->params->plt_style == PLT_OLD)
3972 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3973 else if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3974 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
3975 && (h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "_mcount",
3976 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE)) != NULL
3977 && (h->type == STT_FUNC
3978 || h->needs_plt)
3979 && h->ref_regular
3980 && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
3981 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
3982 {
3983 /* Profiling of shared libs (and pies) is not supported with
3984 secure plt, because ppc32 does profiling before a
3985 function prologue and a secure plt pic call stubs needs
3986 r30 to be set up. */
3987 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3988 }
3989 else
3990 {
3991 bfd *ibfd;
3992 enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type = htab->params->plt_style;
3993
3994 /* Look through the reloc flags left by ppc_elf_check_relocs.
3995 Use the old style bss plt if a file makes plt calls
3996 without using the new relocs, and if ld isn't given
3997 --secure-plt and we never see REL16 relocs. */
3998 if (plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3999 plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4000 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4001 if (is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
4002 {
4003 if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_rel16)
4004 plt_type = PLT_NEW;
4005 else if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->makes_plt_call)
4006 {
4007 plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4008 htab->old_bfd = ibfd;
4009 break;
4010 }
4011 }
4012 htab->plt_type = plt_type;
4013 }
4014 }
4015 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD && htab->params->plt_style == PLT_NEW)
4016 {
4017 if (htab->old_bfd != NULL)
4018 _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced due to %pB"), htab->old_bfd);
4019 else
4020 _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced by profiling"));
4021 }
4022
4023 BFD_ASSERT (htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS);
4024
4025 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
4026 {
4027 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
4028 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
4029
4030 /* The new PLT is a loaded section. */
4031 if (htab->elf.splt != NULL
4032 && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.splt, flags))
4033 return -1;
4034
4035 /* The new GOT is not executable. */
4036 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
4037 && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.sgot, flags))
4038 return -1;
4039 }
4040 else
4041 {
4042 /* Stop an unused .glink section from affecting .text alignment. */
4043 if (htab->glink != NULL
4044 && !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->glink, 0))
4045 return -1;
4046 }
4047 return htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW;
4048 }
4049 \f
4050 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
4051 relocation. */
4052
4053 static asection *
4054 ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
4055 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4056 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4057 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4058 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
4059 {
4060 if (h != NULL)
4061 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
4062 {
4063 case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
4064 case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
4065 return NULL;
4066 }
4067
4068 return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
4069 }
4070
4071 static bfd_boolean
4072 get_sym_h (struct elf_link_hash_entry **hp,
4073 Elf_Internal_Sym **symp,
4074 asection **symsecp,
4075 unsigned char **tls_maskp,
4076 Elf_Internal_Sym **locsymsp,
4077 unsigned long r_symndx,
4078 bfd *ibfd)
4079 {
4080 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4081
4082 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4083 {
4084 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4085 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4086
4087 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4088 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4089 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4090 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4091
4092 if (hp != NULL)
4093 *hp = h;
4094
4095 if (symp != NULL)
4096 *symp = NULL;
4097
4098 if (symsecp != NULL)
4099 {
4100 asection *symsec = NULL;
4101 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4102 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4103 symsec = h->root.u.def.section;
4104 *symsecp = symsec;
4105 }
4106
4107 if (tls_maskp != NULL)
4108 *tls_maskp = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
4109 }
4110 else
4111 {
4112 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4113 Elf_Internal_Sym *locsyms = *locsymsp;
4114
4115 if (locsyms == NULL)
4116 {
4117 locsyms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
4118 if (locsyms == NULL)
4119 locsyms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr,
4120 symtab_hdr->sh_info,
4121 0, NULL, NULL, NULL);
4122 if (locsyms == NULL)
4123 return FALSE;
4124 *locsymsp = locsyms;
4125 }
4126 sym = locsyms + r_symndx;
4127
4128 if (hp != NULL)
4129 *hp = NULL;
4130
4131 if (symp != NULL)
4132 *symp = sym;
4133
4134 if (symsecp != NULL)
4135 *symsecp = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, sym->st_shndx);
4136
4137 if (tls_maskp != NULL)
4138 {
4139 bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
4140 unsigned char *tls_mask;
4141
4142 tls_mask = NULL;
4143 local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
4144 if (local_got != NULL)
4145 {
4146 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
4147 (local_got + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4148 unsigned char *lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
4149 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4150 tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
4151 }
4152 *tls_maskp = tls_mask;
4153 }
4154 }
4155 return TRUE;
4156 }
4157 \f
4158 /* Analyze inline PLT call relocations to see whether calls to locally
4159 defined functions can be converted to direct calls. */
4160
4161 bfd_boolean
4162 ppc_elf_inline_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info)
4163 {
4164 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4165 bfd *ibfd;
4166 asection *sec;
4167 bfd_vma low_vma, high_vma, limit;
4168
4169 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4170 if (htab == NULL)
4171 return FALSE;
4172
4173 /* A bl insn can reach -0x2000000 to 0x1fffffc. The limit is
4174 reduced somewhat to cater for possible stubs that might be added
4175 between the call and its destination. */
4176 limit = 0x1e00000;
4177 low_vma = -1;
4178 high_vma = 0;
4179 for (sec = info->output_bfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4180 if ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE)) == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE))
4181 {
4182 if (low_vma > sec->vma)
4183 low_vma = sec->vma;
4184 if (high_vma < sec->vma + sec->size)
4185 high_vma = sec->vma + sec->size;
4186 }
4187
4188 /* If a "bl" can reach anywhere in local code sections, then we can
4189 convert all inline PLT sequences to direct calls when the symbol
4190 is local. */
4191 if (high_vma - low_vma < limit)
4192 {
4193 htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt = 1;
4194 return TRUE;
4195 }
4196
4197 /* Otherwise, go looking through relocs for cases where a direct
4198 call won't reach. Mark the symbol on any such reloc to disable
4199 the optimization and keep the PLT entry as it seems likely that
4200 this will be better than creating trampolines. Note that this
4201 will disable the optimization for all inline PLT calls to a
4202 particular symbol, not just those that won't reach. The
4203 difficulty in doing a more precise optimization is that the
4204 linker needs to make a decision depending on whether a
4205 particular R_PPC_PLTCALL insn can be turned into a direct
4206 call, for each of the R_PPC_PLTSEQ and R_PPC_PLT16* insns in
4207 the sequence, and there is nothing that ties those relocs
4208 together except their symbol. */
4209
4210 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4211 {
4212 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
4213 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
4214
4215 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
4216 continue;
4217
4218 local_syms = NULL;
4219 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4220
4221 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4222 if (sec->has_pltcall
4223 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
4224 {
4225 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
4226
4227 /* Read the relocations. */
4228 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
4229 info->keep_memory);
4230 if (relstart == NULL)
4231 return FALSE;
4232
4233 relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
4234 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; )
4235 {
4236 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
4237 unsigned long r_symndx;
4238 asection *sym_sec;
4239 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4240 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4241 unsigned char *tls_maskp;
4242
4243 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4244 if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTCALL)
4245 continue;
4246
4247 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4248 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, &tls_maskp, &local_syms,
4249 r_symndx, ibfd))
4250 {
4251 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4252 free (relstart);
4253 if (local_syms != NULL
4254 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
4255 free (local_syms);
4256 return FALSE;
4257 }
4258
4259 if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
4260 {
4261 bfd_vma from, to;
4262 if (h != NULL)
4263 to = h->root.u.def.value;
4264 else
4265 to = sym->st_value;
4266 to += (rel->r_addend
4267 + sym_sec->output_offset
4268 + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
4269 from = (rel->r_offset
4270 + sec->output_offset
4271 + sec->output_section->vma);
4272 if (to - from + limit < 2 * limit)
4273 *tls_maskp &= ~PLT_KEEP;
4274 }
4275 }
4276 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4277 free (relstart);
4278 }
4279
4280 if (local_syms != NULL
4281 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
4282 {
4283 if (!info->keep_memory)
4284 free (local_syms);
4285 else
4286 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
4287 }
4288 }
4289
4290 return TRUE;
4291 }
4292
4293 /* Set plt output section type, htab->tls_get_addr, and call the
4294 generic ELF tls_setup function. */
4295
4296 asection *
4297 ppc_elf_tls_setup (bfd *obfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4298 {
4299 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4300
4301 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4302 htab->tls_get_addr = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
4303 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4304 if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
4305 htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = TRUE;
4306
4307 if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
4308 {
4309 struct elf_link_hash_entry *opt, *tga;
4310 opt = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr_opt",
4311 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4312 if (opt != NULL
4313 && (opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4314 || opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
4315 {
4316 /* If glibc supports an optimized __tls_get_addr call stub,
4317 signalled by the presence of __tls_get_addr_opt, and we'll
4318 be calling __tls_get_addr via a plt call stub, then
4319 make __tls_get_addr point to __tls_get_addr_opt. */
4320 tga = htab->tls_get_addr;
4321 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
4322 && tga != NULL
4323 && (tga->type == STT_FUNC
4324 || tga->needs_plt)
4325 && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, tga)
4326 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, tga)))
4327 {
4328 struct plt_entry *ent;
4329 for (ent = tga->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4330 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4331 break;
4332 if (ent != NULL)
4333 {
4334 tga->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
4335 tga->root.u.i.link = &opt->root;
4336 ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt, tga);
4337 opt->mark = 1;
4338 if (opt->dynindx != -1)
4339 {
4340 /* Use __tls_get_addr_opt in dynamic relocations. */
4341 opt->dynindx = -1;
4342 _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
4343 opt->dynstr_index);
4344 if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, opt))
4345 return FALSE;
4346 }
4347 htab->tls_get_addr = opt;
4348 }
4349 }
4350 }
4351 else
4352 htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = TRUE;
4353 }
4354 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
4355 && htab->elf.splt != NULL
4356 && htab->elf.splt->output_section != NULL)
4357 {
4358 elf_section_type (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHT_PROGBITS;
4359 elf_section_flags (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE;
4360 }
4361
4362 return _bfd_elf_tls_setup (obfd, info);
4363 }
4364
4365 /* Return TRUE iff REL is a branch reloc with a global symbol matching
4366 HASH. */
4367
4368 static bfd_boolean
4369 branch_reloc_hash_match (const bfd *ibfd,
4370 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4371 const struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash)
4372 {
4373 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4374 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4375 unsigned int r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4376
4377 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
4378 {
4379 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4380 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4381
4382 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4383 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4384 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4385 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4386 if (h == hash)
4387 return TRUE;
4388 }
4389 return FALSE;
4390 }
4391
4392 /* Run through all the TLS relocs looking for optimization
4393 opportunities. */
4394
4395 bfd_boolean
4396 ppc_elf_tls_optimize (bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4397 struct bfd_link_info *info)
4398 {
4399 bfd *ibfd;
4400 asection *sec;
4401 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4402 int pass;
4403
4404 if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
4405 return TRUE;
4406
4407 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4408 if (htab == NULL)
4409 return FALSE;
4410
4411 /* Make two passes through the relocs. First time check that tls
4412 relocs involved in setting up a tls_get_addr call are indeed
4413 followed by such a call. If they are not, don't do any tls
4414 optimization. On the second pass twiddle tls_mask flags to
4415 notify relocate_section that optimization can be done, and
4416 adjust got and plt refcounts. */
4417 for (pass = 0; pass < 2; ++pass)
4418 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4419 {
4420 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4421 asection *got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".got2");
4422
4423 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4424 if (sec->has_tls_reloc && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
4425 {
4426 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
4427 int expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
4428
4429 /* Read the relocations. */
4430 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
4431 info->keep_memory);
4432 if (relstart == NULL)
4433 return FALSE;
4434
4435 relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
4436 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
4437 {
4438 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
4439 unsigned long r_symndx;
4440 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
4441 unsigned char *tls_mask;
4442 unsigned char tls_set, tls_clear;
4443 bfd_boolean is_local;
4444 bfd_signed_vma *got_count;
4445
4446 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4447 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4448 {
4449 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4450
4451 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4452 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4453 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4454 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4455 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4456 }
4457
4458 is_local = SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h);
4459 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4460 /* If this section has old-style __tls_get_addr calls
4461 without marker relocs, then check that each
4462 __tls_get_addr call reloc is preceded by a reloc
4463 that conceivably belongs to the __tls_get_addr arg
4464 setup insn. If we don't find matching arg setup
4465 relocs, don't do any tls optimization. */
4466 if (pass == 0
4467 && sec->has_tls_get_addr_call
4468 && h != NULL
4469 && h == htab->tls_get_addr
4470 && !expecting_tls_get_addr
4471 && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
4472 {
4473 info->callbacks->minfo ("%H __tls_get_addr lost arg, "
4474 "TLS optimization disabled\n",
4475 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
4476 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4477 free (relstart);
4478 return TRUE;
4479 }
4480
4481 expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
4482 switch (r_type)
4483 {
4484 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
4485 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
4486 expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
4487 /* Fall through. */
4488
4489 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
4490 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
4491 /* These relocs should never be against a symbol
4492 defined in a shared lib. Leave them alone if
4493 that turns out to be the case. */
4494 if (!is_local)
4495 continue;
4496
4497 /* LD -> LE */
4498 tls_set = 0;
4499 tls_clear = TLS_LD;
4500 break;
4501
4502 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
4503 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
4504 expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
4505 /* Fall through. */
4506
4507 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
4508 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
4509 if (is_local)
4510 /* GD -> LE */
4511 tls_set = 0;
4512 else
4513 /* GD -> IE */
4514 tls_set = TLS_TLS | TLS_GDIE;
4515 tls_clear = TLS_GD;
4516 break;
4517
4518 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
4519 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
4520 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
4521 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
4522 if (is_local)
4523 {
4524 /* IE -> LE */
4525 tls_set = 0;
4526 tls_clear = TLS_TPREL;
4527 break;
4528 }
4529 else
4530 continue;
4531
4532 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
4533 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
4534 if (rel + 1 < relend
4535 && is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
4536 {
4537 if (pass != 0
4538 && ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) != R_PPC_PLTSEQ)
4539 {
4540 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info);
4541 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel[1].r_info);
4542 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4543 {
4544 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4545
4546 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4547 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4548 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4549 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4550 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4551 if (h != NULL)
4552 {
4553 struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
4554 bfd_vma addend = 0;
4555
4556 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4557 addend = rel->r_addend;
4558 ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist,
4559 got2, addend);
4560 if (ent != NULL
4561 && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4562 ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
4563 }
4564 }
4565 }
4566 continue;
4567 }
4568 expecting_tls_get_addr = 2;
4569 tls_set = 0;
4570 tls_clear = 0;
4571 break;
4572
4573 default:
4574 continue;
4575 }
4576
4577 if (pass == 0)
4578 {
4579 if (!expecting_tls_get_addr
4580 || !sec->has_tls_get_addr_call)
4581 continue;
4582
4583 if (rel + 1 < relend
4584 && branch_reloc_hash_match (ibfd, rel + 1,
4585 htab->tls_get_addr))
4586 continue;
4587
4588 /* Uh oh, we didn't find the expected call. We
4589 could just mark this symbol to exclude it
4590 from tls optimization but it's safer to skip
4591 the entire optimization. */
4592 info->callbacks->minfo (_("%H arg lost __tls_get_addr, "
4593 "TLS optimization disabled\n"),
4594 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
4595 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4596 free (relstart);
4597 return TRUE;
4598 }
4599
4600 if (h != NULL)
4601 {
4602 tls_mask = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
4603 got_count = &h->got.refcount;
4604 }
4605 else
4606 {
4607 bfd_signed_vma *lgot_refs;
4608 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
4609 unsigned char *lgot_masks;
4610
4611 lgot_refs = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
4612 if (lgot_refs == NULL)
4613 abort ();
4614 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
4615 (lgot_refs + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4616 lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
4617 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4618 tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
4619 got_count = &lgot_refs[r_symndx];
4620 }
4621
4622 /* If we don't have old-style __tls_get_addr calls
4623 without TLSGD/TLSLD marker relocs, and we haven't
4624 found a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a
4625 marker for this symbol, then we either have a
4626 broken object file or an -mlongcall style
4627 indirect call to __tls_get_addr without a marker.
4628 Disable optimization in this case. */
4629 if ((tls_clear & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) != 0
4630 && !sec->has_tls_get_addr_call
4631 && ((*tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
4632 != (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK)))
4633 continue;
4634
4635 if (expecting_tls_get_addr)
4636 {
4637 struct plt_entry *ent;
4638 bfd_vma addend = 0;
4639
4640 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
4641 && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTREL24
4642 || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTCALL))
4643 addend = rel[1].r_addend;
4644 ent = find_plt_ent (&htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist,
4645 got2, addend);
4646 if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4647 ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
4648
4649 if (expecting_tls_get_addr == 2)
4650 continue;
4651 }
4652
4653 if (tls_set == 0)
4654 {
4655 /* We managed to get rid of a got entry. */
4656 if (*got_count > 0)
4657 *got_count -= 1;
4658 }
4659
4660 *tls_mask |= tls_set;
4661 *tls_mask &= ~tls_clear;
4662 }
4663
4664 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4665 free (relstart);
4666 }
4667 }
4668 htab->do_tls_opt = 1;
4669 return TRUE;
4670 }
4671 \f
4672 /* Find dynamic relocs for H that apply to read-only sections. */
4673
4674 static asection *
4675 readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4676 {
4677 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
4678
4679 for (p = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
4680 {
4681 asection *s = p->sec->output_section;
4682
4683 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4684 return p->sec;
4685 }
4686 return NULL;
4687 }
4688
4689 /* Return true if we have dynamic relocs against H or any of its weak
4690 aliases, that apply to read-only sections. Cannot be used after
4691 size_dynamic_sections. */
4692
4693 static bfd_boolean
4694 alias_readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4695 {
4696 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
4697 do
4698 {
4699 if (readonly_dynrelocs (&eh->elf))
4700 return TRUE;
4701 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (eh->elf.u.alias);
4702 } while (eh != NULL && &eh->elf != h);
4703
4704 return FALSE;
4705 }
4706
4707 /* Return whether H has pc-relative dynamic relocs. */
4708
4709 static bfd_boolean
4710 pc_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4711 {
4712 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
4713
4714 for (p = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
4715 if (p->pc_count != 0)
4716 return TRUE;
4717 return FALSE;
4718 }
4719
4720 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
4721 regular object. The current definition is in some section of the
4722 dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to
4723 change the definition to something the rest of the link can
4724 understand. */
4725
4726 static bfd_boolean
4727 ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
4728 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4729 {
4730 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4731 asection *s;
4732
4733 #ifdef DEBUG
4734 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol called for %s\n",
4735 h->root.root.string);
4736 #endif
4737
4738 /* Make sure we know what is going on here. */
4739 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4740 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL
4741 && (h->needs_plt
4742 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4743 || h->is_weakalias
4744 || (h->def_dynamic
4745 && h->ref_regular
4746 && !h->def_regular)));
4747
4748 /* Deal with function syms. */
4749 if (h->type == STT_FUNC
4750 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4751 || h->needs_plt)
4752 {
4753 bfd_boolean local = (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
4754 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h));
4755 /* Discard dyn_relocs when non-pic if we've decided that a
4756 function symbol is local. */
4757 if (!bfd_link_pic (info) && local)
4758 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4759
4760 /* Clear procedure linkage table information for any symbol that
4761 won't need a .plt entry. */
4762 struct plt_entry *ent;
4763 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4764 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4765 break;
4766 if (ent == NULL
4767 || (h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
4768 && local
4769 && (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
4770 || (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
4771 & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)))
4772 {
4773 /* A PLT entry is not required/allowed when:
4774
4775 1. We are not using ld.so; because then the PLT entry
4776 can't be set up, so we can't use one. In this case,
4777 ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol won't even be called.
4778
4779 2. GC has rendered the entry unused.
4780
4781 3. We know for certain that a call to this symbol
4782 will go to this object, or will remain undefined. */
4783 h->plt.plist = NULL;
4784 h->needs_plt = 0;
4785 h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
4786 }
4787 else
4788 {
4789 /* Taking a function's address in a read/write section
4790 doesn't require us to define the function symbol in the
4791 executable on a plt call stub. A dynamic reloc can
4792 be used instead, giving better runtime performance.
4793 (Calls via that function pointer don't need to bounce
4794 through the plt call stub.) Similarly, use a dynamic
4795 reloc for a weak reference when possible, allowing the
4796 resolution of the symbol to be set at load time rather
4797 than link time. */
4798 if ((h->pointer_equality_needed
4799 || (h->non_got_ref
4800 && !h->ref_regular_nonweak
4801 && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
4802 && !htab->is_vxworks
4803 && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
4804 && !readonly_dynrelocs (h))
4805 {
4806 h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
4807 /* If we haven't seen a branch reloc and the symbol
4808 isn't an ifunc then we don't need a plt entry. */
4809 if (!h->needs_plt && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
4810 h->plt.plist = NULL;
4811 }
4812 else if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
4813 /* We are going to be defining the function symbol on the
4814 plt stub, so no dyn_relocs needed when non-pic. */
4815 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4816 }
4817 h->protected_def = 0;
4818 /* Function symbols can't have copy relocs. */
4819 return TRUE;
4820 }
4821 else
4822 h->plt.plist = NULL;
4823
4824 /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
4825 processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
4826 real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
4827 if (h->is_weakalias)
4828 {
4829 struct elf_link_hash_entry *def = weakdef (h);
4830 BFD_ASSERT (def->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined);
4831 h->root.u.def.section = def->root.u.def.section;
4832 h->root.u.def.value = def->root.u.def.value;
4833 if (def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynbss
4834 || def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro
4835 || def->root.u.def.section == htab->dynsbss)
4836 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4837 return TRUE;
4838 }
4839
4840 /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
4841 is not a function. */
4842
4843 /* If we are creating a shared library, we must presume that the
4844 only references to the symbol are via the global offset table.
4845 For such cases we need not do anything here; the relocations will
4846 be handled correctly by relocate_section. */
4847 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4848 {
4849 h->protected_def = 0;
4850 return TRUE;
4851 }
4852
4853 /* If there are no references to this symbol that do not use the
4854 GOT, we don't need to generate a copy reloc. */
4855 if (!h->non_got_ref)
4856 {
4857 h->protected_def = 0;
4858 return TRUE;
4859 }
4860
4861 /* Protected variables do not work with .dynbss. The copy in
4862 .dynbss won't be used by the shared library with the protected
4863 definition for the variable. Editing to PIC, or text relocations
4864 are preferable to an incorrect program. */
4865 if (h->protected_def)
4866 {
4867 if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4868 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
4869 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
4870 && htab->params->pic_fixup == 0
4871 && info->disable_target_specific_optimizations <= 1)
4872 htab->params->pic_fixup = 1;
4873 return TRUE;
4874 }
4875
4876 /* If -z nocopyreloc was given, we won't generate them either. */
4877 if (info->nocopyreloc)
4878 return TRUE;
4879
4880 /* If we don't find any dynamic relocs in read-only sections, then
4881 we'll be keeping the dynamic relocs and avoiding the copy reloc.
4882 We can't do this if there are any small data relocations. This
4883 doesn't work on VxWorks, where we can not have dynamic
4884 relocations (other than copy and jump slot relocations) in an
4885 executable. */
4886 if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4887 && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
4888 && !htab->is_vxworks
4889 && !h->def_regular
4890 && !alias_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
4891 return TRUE;
4892
4893 /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
4894 become part of the .bss section of the executable. There will be
4895 an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section. The dynamic
4896 object will contain position independent code, so all references
4897 from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
4898 offset table. The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
4899 determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
4900 both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
4901 same memory location for the variable.
4902
4903 Of course, if the symbol is referenced using SDAREL relocs, we
4904 must instead allocate it in .sbss. */
4905 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
4906 s = htab->dynsbss;
4907 else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4908 s = htab->elf.sdynrelro;
4909 else
4910 s = htab->elf.sdynbss;
4911 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
4912
4913 if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0 && h->size != 0)
4914 {
4915 asection *srel;
4916
4917 /* We must generate a R_PPC_COPY reloc to tell the dynamic
4918 linker to copy the initial value out of the dynamic object
4919 and into the runtime process image. */
4920 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
4921 srel = htab->relsbss;
4922 else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4923 srel = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
4924 else
4925 srel = htab->elf.srelbss;
4926 BFD_ASSERT (srel != NULL);
4927 srel->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
4928 h->needs_copy = 1;
4929 }
4930
4931 /* We no longer want dyn_relocs. */
4932 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4933 return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (info, h, s);
4934 }
4935 \f
4936 /* Generate a symbol to mark plt call stubs. For non-PIC code the sym is
4937 xxxxxxxx.plt_call32.<callee> where xxxxxxxx is a hex number, usually 0,
4938 specifying the addend on the plt relocation. For -fpic code, the sym
4939 is xxxxxxxx.plt_pic32.<callee>, and for -fPIC
4940 xxxxxxxx.got2.plt_pic32.<callee>. */
4941
4942 static bfd_boolean
4943 add_stub_sym (struct plt_entry *ent,
4944 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4945 struct bfd_link_info *info)
4946 {
4947 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
4948 size_t len1, len2, len3;
4949 char *name;
4950 const char *stub;
4951 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4952
4953 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4954 stub = ".plt_pic32.";
4955 else
4956 stub = ".plt_call32.";
4957
4958 len1 = strlen (h->root.root.string);
4959 len2 = strlen (stub);
4960 len3 = 0;
4961 if (ent->sec)
4962 len3 = strlen (ent->sec->name);
4963 name = bfd_malloc (len1 + len2 + len3 + 9);
4964 if (name == NULL)
4965 return FALSE;
4966 sprintf (name, "%08x", (unsigned) ent->addend & 0xffffffff);
4967 if (ent->sec)
4968 memcpy (name + 8, ent->sec->name, len3);
4969 memcpy (name + 8 + len3, stub, len2);
4970 memcpy (name + 8 + len3 + len2, h->root.root.string, len1 + 1);
4971 sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, name, TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
4972 if (sh == NULL)
4973 return FALSE;
4974 if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
4975 {
4976 sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
4977 sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
4978 sh->root.u.def.value = ent->glink_offset;
4979 sh->ref_regular = 1;
4980 sh->def_regular = 1;
4981 sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
4982 sh->forced_local = 1;
4983 sh->non_elf = 0;
4984 sh->root.linker_def = 1;
4985 }
4986 return TRUE;
4987 }
4988
4989 /* Allocate NEED contiguous space in .got, and return the offset.
4990 Handles allocation of the got header when crossing 32k. */
4991
4992 static bfd_vma
4993 allocate_got (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab, unsigned int need)
4994 {
4995 bfd_vma where;
4996 unsigned int max_before_header;
4997
4998 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
4999 {
5000 where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5001 htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
5002 }
5003 else
5004 {
5005 max_before_header = htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW ? 32768 : 32764;
5006 if (need <= htab->got_gap)
5007 {
5008 where = max_before_header - htab->got_gap;
5009 htab->got_gap -= need;
5010 }
5011 else
5012 {
5013 if (htab->elf.sgot->size + need > max_before_header
5014 && htab->elf.sgot->size <= max_before_header)
5015 {
5016 htab->got_gap = max_before_header - htab->elf.sgot->size;
5017 htab->elf.sgot->size = max_before_header + htab->got_header_size;
5018 }
5019 where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5020 htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
5021 }
5022 }
5023 return where;
5024 }
5025
5026 /* Calculate size of GOT entries for symbol given its TLS_MASK.
5027 TLS_LD is excluded because those go in a special GOT slot. */
5028
5029 static inline unsigned int
5030 got_entries_needed (int tls_mask)
5031 {
5032 unsigned int need;
5033 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) == 0)
5034 need = 4;
5035 else
5036 {
5037 need = 0;
5038 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
5039 need += 8;
5040 if ((tls_mask & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
5041 need += 4;
5042 if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
5043 need += 4;
5044 }
5045 return need;
5046 }
5047
5048 /* If H is undefined, make it dynamic if that makes sense. */
5049
5050 static bfd_boolean
5051 ensure_undef_dynamic (struct bfd_link_info *info,
5052 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5053 {
5054 struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
5055
5056 if (htab->dynamic_sections_created
5057 && ((info->dynamic_undefined_weak != 0
5058 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
5059 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
5060 && h->dynindx == -1
5061 && !h->forced_local
5062 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT)
5063 return bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h);
5064 return TRUE;
5065 }
5066
5067 /* Allocate space in associated reloc sections for dynamic relocs. */
5068
5069 static bfd_boolean
5070 allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
5071 {
5072 struct bfd_link_info *info = inf;
5073 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
5074 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5075 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
5076 bfd_boolean dyn;
5077
5078 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
5079 return TRUE;
5080
5081 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5082 eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
5083 if (eh->elf.got.refcount > 0
5084 || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
5085 && !eh->elf.def_regular
5086 && eh->elf.protected_def
5087 && eh->has_addr16_ha
5088 && eh->has_addr16_lo
5089 && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
5090 {
5091 unsigned int need;
5092
5093 /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5094 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, &eh->elf))
5095 return FALSE;
5096
5097 need = 0;
5098 if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5099 {
5100 if (SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf))
5101 /* We'll just use htab->tlsld_got.offset. This should
5102 always be the case. It's a little odd if we have
5103 a local dynamic reloc against a non-local symbol. */
5104 htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
5105 else
5106 need += 8;
5107 }
5108 need += got_entries_needed (eh->tls_mask);
5109 if (need == 0)
5110 eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5111 else
5112 {
5113 eh->elf.got.offset = allocate_got (htab, need);
5114 if (((bfd_link_pic (info)
5115 && !((eh->tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
5116 && bfd_link_executable (info)
5117 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf)))
5118 || (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5119 && eh->elf.dynindx != -1
5120 && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf)))
5121 && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, &eh->elf))
5122 {
5123 asection *rsec;
5124
5125 need *= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
5126 if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5127 need -= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5128 rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
5129 if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5130 rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
5131 rsec->size += need;
5132 }
5133 }
5134 }
5135 else
5136 eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5137
5138 /* If no dynamic sections we can't have dynamic relocs, except for
5139 IFUNCs which are handled even in static executables. */
5140 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5141 && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5142 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5143
5144 /* Discard relocs on undefined symbols that must be local. */
5145 else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
5146 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT)
5147 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5148
5149 /* Also discard relocs on undefined weak syms with non-default
5150 visibility, or when dynamic_undefined_weak says so. */
5151 else if (UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
5152 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5153
5154 if (eh->dyn_relocs == NULL)
5155 ;
5156
5157 /* In the shared -Bsymbolic case, discard space allocated for
5158 dynamic pc-relative relocs against symbols which turn out to be
5159 defined in regular objects. For the normal shared case, discard
5160 space for relocs that have become local due to symbol visibility
5161 changes. */
5162 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5163 {
5164 /* Relocs that use pc_count are those that appear on a call insn,
5165 or certain REL relocs (see must_be_dyn_reloc) that can be
5166 generated via assembly. We want calls to protected symbols to
5167 resolve directly to the function rather than going via the plt.
5168 If people want function pointer comparisons to work as expected
5169 then they should avoid writing weird assembly. */
5170 if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h))
5171 {
5172 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
5173
5174 for (pp = &eh->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
5175 {
5176 p->count -= p->pc_count;
5177 p->pc_count = 0;
5178 if (p->count == 0)
5179 *pp = p->next;
5180 else
5181 pp = &p->next;
5182 }
5183 }
5184
5185 if (htab->is_vxworks)
5186 {
5187 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
5188
5189 for (pp = &eh->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
5190 {
5191 if (strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name, ".tls_vars") == 0)
5192 *pp = p->next;
5193 else
5194 pp = &p->next;
5195 }
5196 }
5197
5198 if (eh->dyn_relocs != NULL)
5199 {
5200 /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5201 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5202 return FALSE;
5203 }
5204 }
5205 else if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS)
5206 {
5207 /* For the non-pic case, discard space for relocs against
5208 symbols which turn out to need copy relocs or are not
5209 dynamic. */
5210 if (h->dynamic_adjusted
5211 && !h->def_regular
5212 && !ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (h)
5213 && !(h->protected_def
5214 && eh->has_addr16_ha
5215 && eh->has_addr16_lo
5216 && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
5217 {
5218 /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5219 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5220 return FALSE;
5221
5222 if (h->dynindx == -1)
5223 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5224 }
5225 else
5226 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5227 }
5228
5229 /* Allocate space. */
5230 for (p = eh->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
5231 {
5232 asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
5233 if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5234 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
5235 sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5236 }
5237
5238 /* Handle PLT relocs. Done last, after dynindx has settled.
5239 We might need a PLT entry when the symbol
5240 a) is dynamic, or
5241 b) is an ifunc, or
5242 c) has plt16 relocs and has been processed by adjust_dynamic_symbol, or
5243 d) has plt16 relocs and we are linking statically. */
5244 dyn = htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created && h->dynindx != -1;
5245 if (dyn
5246 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
5247 || (h->needs_plt && h->dynamic_adjusted)
5248 || (h->needs_plt
5249 && h->def_regular
5250 && !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5251 && !htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
5252 && (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
5253 & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) == PLT_KEEP))
5254 {
5255 struct plt_entry *ent;
5256 bfd_boolean doneone = FALSE;
5257 bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5258
5259 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5260 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5261 {
5262 asection *s = htab->elf.splt;
5263
5264 if (!dyn)
5265 {
5266 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5267 s = htab->elf.iplt;
5268 else
5269 s = htab->pltlocal;
5270 }
5271
5272 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn)
5273 {
5274 if (!doneone)
5275 {
5276 plt_offset = s->size;
5277 s->size += 4;
5278 }
5279 ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5280
5281 if (s == htab->pltlocal)
5282 ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5283 else
5284 {
5285 s = htab->glink;
5286 if (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info))
5287 {
5288 glink_offset = s->size;
5289 s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
5290 }
5291 if (!doneone
5292 && !bfd_link_pic (info)
5293 && h->def_dynamic
5294 && !h->def_regular)
5295 {
5296 h->root.u.def.section = s;
5297 h->root.u.def.value = glink_offset;
5298 }
5299 ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5300
5301 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms
5302 && !add_stub_sym (ent, h, info))
5303 return FALSE;
5304 }
5305 }
5306 else
5307 {
5308 if (!doneone)
5309 {
5310 /* If this is the first .plt entry, make room
5311 for the special first entry. */
5312 if (s->size == 0)
5313 s->size += htab->plt_initial_entry_size;
5314
5315 /* The PowerPC PLT is actually composed of two
5316 parts, the first part is 2 words (for a load
5317 and a jump), and then there is a remaining
5318 word available at the end. */
5319 plt_offset = (htab->plt_initial_entry_size
5320 + (htab->plt_slot_size
5321 * ((s->size
5322 - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5323 / htab->plt_entry_size)));
5324
5325 /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular
5326 file, and we are not generating a shared
5327 library, then set the symbol to this location
5328 in the .plt. This is to avoid text
5329 relocations, and is required to make
5330 function pointers compare as equal between
5331 the normal executable and the shared library. */
5332 if (! bfd_link_pic (info)
5333 && h->def_dynamic
5334 && !h->def_regular)
5335 {
5336 h->root.u.def.section = s;
5337 h->root.u.def.value = plt_offset;
5338 }
5339
5340 /* Make room for this entry. */
5341 s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
5342 /* After the 8192nd entry, room for two entries
5343 is allocated. */
5344 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
5345 && (s->size - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5346 / htab->plt_entry_size
5347 > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES)
5348 s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
5349 }
5350 ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5351 }
5352
5353 /* We also need to make an entry in the .rela.plt section. */
5354 if (!doneone)
5355 {
5356 if (!dyn)
5357 {
5358 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5359 {
5360 s = htab->elf.irelplt;
5361 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5362 }
5363 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5364 {
5365 s = htab->relpltlocal;
5366 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5367 }
5368 }
5369 else
5370 {
5371 htab->elf.srelplt->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5372
5373 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
5374 {
5375 /* Allocate space for the unloaded relocations. */
5376 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
5377 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5378 {
5379 if (ent->plt.offset
5380 == (bfd_vma) htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5381 {
5382 htab->srelplt2->size
5383 += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
5384 * VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS);
5385 }
5386
5387 htab->srelplt2->size
5388 += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
5389 * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS);
5390 }
5391
5392 /* Every PLT entry has an associated GOT entry in
5393 .got.plt. */
5394 htab->elf.sgotplt->size += 4;
5395 }
5396 }
5397 doneone = TRUE;
5398 }
5399 }
5400 else
5401 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5402
5403 if (!doneone)
5404 {
5405 h->plt.plist = NULL;
5406 h->needs_plt = 0;
5407 }
5408 }
5409 else
5410 {
5411 h->plt.plist = NULL;
5412 h->needs_plt = 0;
5413 }
5414
5415 return TRUE;
5416 }
5417
5418 /* Set DF_TEXTREL if we find any dynamic relocs that apply to
5419 read-only sections. */
5420
5421 static bfd_boolean
5422 maybe_set_textrel (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *info_p)
5423 {
5424 asection *sec;
5425
5426 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
5427 return TRUE;
5428
5429 sec = readonly_dynrelocs (h);
5430 if (sec != NULL)
5431 {
5432 struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) info_p;
5433
5434 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5435 info->callbacks->minfo
5436 (_("%pB: dynamic relocation against `%pT' in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
5437 sec->owner, h->root.root.string, sec);
5438
5439 /* Not an error, just cut short the traversal. */
5440 return FALSE;
5441 }
5442 return TRUE;
5443 }
5444
5445 static const unsigned char glink_eh_frame_cie[] =
5446 {
5447 0, 0, 0, 16, /* length. */
5448 0, 0, 0, 0, /* id. */
5449 1, /* CIE version. */
5450 'z', 'R', 0, /* Augmentation string. */
5451 4, /* Code alignment. */
5452 0x7c, /* Data alignment. */
5453 65, /* RA reg. */
5454 1, /* Augmentation size. */
5455 DW_EH_PE_pcrel | DW_EH_PE_sdata4, /* FDE encoding. */
5456 DW_CFA_def_cfa, 1, 0 /* def_cfa: r1 offset 0. */
5457 };
5458
5459 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */
5460
5461 static bfd_boolean
5462 ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
5463 struct bfd_link_info *info)
5464 {
5465 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5466 asection *s;
5467 bfd_boolean relocs;
5468 bfd *ibfd;
5469
5470 #ifdef DEBUG
5471 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections called\n");
5472 #endif
5473
5474 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5475 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL);
5476
5477 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
5478 {
5479 /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */
5480 if (bfd_link_executable (info) && !info->nointerp)
5481 {
5482 s = bfd_get_linker_section (htab->elf.dynobj, ".interp");
5483 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
5484 s->size = sizeof ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
5485 s->contents = (unsigned char *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
5486 }
5487 }
5488
5489 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
5490 htab->got_header_size = 16;
5491 else if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
5492 htab->got_header_size = 12;
5493
5494 /* Set up .got offsets for local syms, and space for local dynamic
5495 relocs. */
5496 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
5497 {
5498 bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
5499 bfd_signed_vma *end_local_got;
5500 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
5501 struct plt_entry **end_local_plt;
5502 char *lgot_masks;
5503 bfd_size_type locsymcount;
5504 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
5505
5506 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
5507 continue;
5508
5509 for (s = ibfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5510 {
5511 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
5512
5513 for (p = ((struct ppc_dyn_relocs *)
5514 elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel);
5515 p != NULL;
5516 p = p->next)
5517 {
5518 if (!bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec)
5519 && bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec->output_section))
5520 {
5521 /* Input section has been discarded, either because
5522 it is a copy of a linkonce section or due to
5523 linker script /DISCARD/, so we'll be discarding
5524 the relocs too. */
5525 }
5526 else if (htab->is_vxworks
5527 && strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name,
5528 ".tls_vars") == 0)
5529 {
5530 /* Relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections are
5531 handled specially by the loader. */
5532 }
5533 else if (p->count != 0)
5534 {
5535 asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
5536 if (p->ifunc)
5537 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
5538 sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5539 if ((p->sec->output_section->flags
5540 & (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
5541 == (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
5542 {
5543 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5544 info->callbacks->minfo (_("%pB: dynamic relocation in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
5545 p->sec->owner, p->sec);
5546 }
5547 }
5548 }
5549 }
5550
5551 local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
5552 if (!local_got)
5553 continue;
5554
5555 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
5556 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5557 end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
5558 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
5559 end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
5560 lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
5561
5562 for (; local_got < end_local_got; ++local_got, ++lgot_masks)
5563 if (*local_got > 0)
5564 {
5565 unsigned int need;
5566 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5567 htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
5568 need = got_entries_needed (*lgot_masks);
5569 if (need == 0)
5570 *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
5571 else
5572 {
5573 *local_got = allocate_got (htab, need);
5574 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
5575 && !((*lgot_masks & TLS_TLS) != 0
5576 && bfd_link_executable (info)))
5577 {
5578 asection *srel;
5579
5580 need *= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
5581 srel = htab->elf.srelgot;
5582 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5583 srel = htab->elf.irelplt;
5584 srel->size += need;
5585 }
5586 }
5587 }
5588 else
5589 *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
5590
5591 if (htab->is_vxworks)
5592 continue;
5593
5594 /* Allocate space for calls to local STT_GNU_IFUNC syms in .iplt. */
5595 lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
5596 for (; local_plt < end_local_plt; ++local_plt, ++lgot_masks)
5597 {
5598 struct plt_entry *ent;
5599 bfd_boolean doneone = FALSE;
5600 bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5601
5602 for (ent = *local_plt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5603 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5604 {
5605 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5606 s = htab->elf.iplt;
5607 else if (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
5608 || (*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)
5609 {
5610 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5611 continue;
5612 }
5613 else
5614 s = htab->pltlocal;
5615
5616 if (!doneone)
5617 {
5618 plt_offset = s->size;
5619 s->size += 4;
5620 }
5621 ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5622
5623 if (s != htab->pltlocal && (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info)))
5624 {
5625 s = htab->glink;
5626 glink_offset = s->size;
5627 s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, NULL);
5628 }
5629 ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5630
5631 if (!doneone)
5632 {
5633 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5634 {
5635 s = htab->elf.irelplt;
5636 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5637 }
5638 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5639 {
5640 s = htab->relpltlocal;
5641 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5642 }
5643 doneone = TRUE;
5644 }
5645 }
5646 else
5647 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5648 }
5649 }
5650
5651 /* Allocate space for global sym dynamic relocs. */
5652 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), allocate_dynrelocs, info);
5653
5654 if (htab->tlsld_got.refcount > 0)
5655 {
5656 htab->tlsld_got.offset = allocate_got (htab, 8);
5657 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
5658 htab->elf.srelgot->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5659 }
5660 else
5661 htab->tlsld_got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5662
5663 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL && htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS)
5664 {
5665 unsigned int g_o_t = 32768;
5666
5667 /* If we haven't allocated the header, do so now. When we get here,
5668 for old plt/got the got size will be 0 to 32764 (not allocated),
5669 or 32780 to 65536 (header allocated). For new plt/got, the
5670 corresponding ranges are 0 to 32768 and 32780 to 65536. */
5671 if (htab->elf.sgot->size <= 32768)
5672 {
5673 g_o_t = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5674 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
5675 g_o_t += 4;
5676 htab->elf.sgot->size += htab->got_header_size;
5677 }
5678
5679 htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value = g_o_t;
5680 }
5681 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5682 {
5683 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
5684
5685 sda->root.u.def.section = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section;
5686 sda->root.u.def.value = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
5687 }
5688 if (info->emitrelocations)
5689 {
5690 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
5691
5692 if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
5693 sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5694 sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
5695 if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
5696 sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5697 }
5698
5699 if (htab->glink != NULL
5700 && htab->glink->size != 0
5701 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5702 {
5703 htab->glink_pltresolve = htab->glink->size;
5704 /* Space for the branch table. */
5705 htab->glink->size
5706 += htab->elf.srelplt->size / (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4) - 4;
5707 /* Pad out to align the start of PLTresolve. */
5708 htab->glink->size += -htab->glink->size & (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
5709 ? 63 : 15);
5710 htab->glink->size += GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
5711
5712 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
5713 {
5714 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
5715 sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink",
5716 TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
5717 if (sh == NULL)
5718 return FALSE;
5719 if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5720 {
5721 sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5722 sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5723 sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink_pltresolve;
5724 sh->ref_regular = 1;
5725 sh->def_regular = 1;
5726 sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5727 sh->forced_local = 1;
5728 sh->non_elf = 0;
5729 sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5730 }
5731 sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink_PLTresolve",
5732 TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
5733 if (sh == NULL)
5734 return FALSE;
5735 if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5736 {
5737 sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5738 sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5739 sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
5740 sh->ref_regular = 1;
5741 sh->def_regular = 1;
5742 sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5743 sh->forced_local = 1;
5744 sh->non_elf = 0;
5745 sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5746 }
5747 }
5748 }
5749
5750 if (htab->glink != NULL
5751 && htab->glink->size != 0
5752 && htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
5753 && !bfd_is_abs_section (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section)
5754 && _bfd_elf_eh_frame_present (info))
5755 {
5756 s = htab->glink_eh_frame;
5757 s->size = sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + 20;
5758 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5759 {
5760 s->size += 4;
5761 if (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8 >= 256)
5762 s->size += 4;
5763 }
5764 }
5765
5766 /* We've now determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections.
5767 Allocate memory for them. */
5768 relocs = FALSE;
5769 for (s = htab->elf.dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5770 {
5771 bfd_boolean strip_section = TRUE;
5772
5773 if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
5774 continue;
5775
5776 if (s == htab->elf.splt
5777 || s == htab->elf.sgot)
5778 {
5779 /* We'd like to strip these sections if they aren't needed, but if
5780 we've exported dynamic symbols from them we must leave them.
5781 It's too late to tell BFD to get rid of the symbols. */
5782 if (htab->elf.hplt != NULL)
5783 strip_section = FALSE;
5784 /* Strip this section if we don't need it; see the
5785 comment below. */
5786 }
5787 else if (s == htab->elf.iplt
5788 || s == htab->pltlocal
5789 || s == htab->glink
5790 || s == htab->glink_eh_frame
5791 || s == htab->elf.sgotplt
5792 || s == htab->sbss
5793 || s == htab->elf.sdynbss
5794 || s == htab->elf.sdynrelro
5795 || s == htab->dynsbss)
5796 {
5797 /* Strip these too. */
5798 }
5799 else if (s == htab->sdata[0].section
5800 || s == htab->sdata[1].section)
5801 {
5802 strip_section = (s->flags & SEC_KEEP) == 0;
5803 }
5804 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (bfd_section_name (s), ".rela"))
5805 {
5806 if (s->size != 0)
5807 {
5808 /* Remember whether there are any relocation sections. */
5809 relocs = TRUE;
5810
5811 /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
5812 to copy relocs into the output file. */
5813 s->reloc_count = 0;
5814 }
5815 }
5816 else
5817 {
5818 /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */
5819 continue;
5820 }
5821
5822 if (s->size == 0 && strip_section)
5823 {
5824 /* If we don't need this section, strip it from the
5825 output file. This is mostly to handle .rela.bss and
5826 .rela.plt. We must create both sections in
5827 create_dynamic_sections, because they must be created
5828 before the linker maps input sections to output
5829 sections. The linker does that before
5830 adjust_dynamic_symbol is called, and it is that
5831 function which decides whether anything needs to go
5832 into these sections. */
5833 s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
5834 continue;
5835 }
5836
5837 if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
5838 continue;
5839
5840 /* Allocate memory for the section contents. */
5841 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->elf.dynobj, s->size);
5842 if (s->contents == NULL)
5843 return FALSE;
5844 }
5845
5846 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5847 {
5848 /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the
5849 values later, in ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
5850 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
5851 the .dynamic section. The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
5852 dynamic linker and used by the debugger. */
5853 #define add_dynamic_entry(TAG, VAL) \
5854 _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, TAG, VAL)
5855
5856 if (bfd_link_executable (info))
5857 {
5858 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_DEBUG, 0))
5859 return FALSE;
5860 }
5861
5862 if (htab->elf.splt != NULL && htab->elf.splt->size != 0)
5863 {
5864 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTGOT, 0)
5865 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTRELSZ, 0)
5866 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTREL, DT_RELA)
5867 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_JMPREL, 0))
5868 return FALSE;
5869 }
5870
5871 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
5872 && htab->glink != NULL
5873 && htab->glink->size != 0)
5874 {
5875 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_GOT, 0))
5876 return FALSE;
5877 if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt
5878 && htab->tls_get_addr != NULL
5879 && htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist != NULL
5880 && !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_OPT, PPC_OPT_TLS))
5881 return FALSE;
5882 }
5883
5884 if (relocs)
5885 {
5886 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELA, 0)
5887 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELASZ, 0)
5888 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELAENT, sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)))
5889 return FALSE;
5890 }
5891
5892 /* If any dynamic relocs apply to a read-only section, then we
5893 need a DT_TEXTREL entry. */
5894 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) == 0)
5895 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), maybe_set_textrel,
5896 info);
5897
5898 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) != 0)
5899 {
5900 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_TEXTREL, 0))
5901 return FALSE;
5902 }
5903 if (htab->is_vxworks
5904 && !elf_vxworks_add_dynamic_entries (output_bfd, info))
5905 return FALSE;
5906 }
5907 #undef add_dynamic_entry
5908
5909 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
5910 && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
5911 {
5912 unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
5913 bfd_vma val;
5914
5915 memcpy (p, glink_eh_frame_cie, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie));
5916 /* CIE length (rewrite in case little-endian). */
5917 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) - 4, p);
5918 p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
5919 /* FDE length. */
5920 val = htab->glink_eh_frame->size - 4 - sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
5921 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
5922 p += 4;
5923 /* CIE pointer. */
5924 val = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
5925 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
5926 p += 4;
5927 /* Offset to .glink. Set later. */
5928 p += 4;
5929 /* .glink size. */
5930 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->glink->size, p);
5931 p += 4;
5932 /* Augmentation. */
5933 p += 1;
5934
5935 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
5936 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5937 {
5938 bfd_vma adv = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8) >> 2;
5939 if (adv < 64)
5940 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + adv;
5941 else if (adv < 256)
5942 {
5943 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc1;
5944 *p++ = adv;
5945 }
5946 else if (adv < 65536)
5947 {
5948 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc2;
5949 bfd_put_16 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
5950 p += 2;
5951 }
5952 else
5953 {
5954 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc4;
5955 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
5956 p += 4;
5957 }
5958 *p++ = DW_CFA_register;
5959 *p++ = 65;
5960 p++;
5961 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 4;
5962 *p++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
5963 *p++ = 65;
5964 }
5965 BFD_ASSERT ((bfd_vma) ((p + 3 - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents) & -4)
5966 == htab->glink_eh_frame->size);
5967 }
5968
5969 return TRUE;
5970 }
5971
5972 /* Arrange to have _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_ stripped from the output
5973 if it looks like nothing is using them. */
5974
5975 static void
5976 maybe_strip_sdasym (bfd *output_bfd, elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
5977 {
5978 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = lsect->sym;
5979
5980 if (sda != NULL && !sda->ref_regular && sda->dynindx == -1)
5981 {
5982 asection *s;
5983
5984 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->name);
5985 if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
5986 {
5987 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->bss_name);
5988 if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
5989 {
5990 sda->def_regular = 0;
5991 /* This is somewhat magic. See elf_link_output_extsym. */
5992 sda->ref_dynamic = 1;
5993 sda->forced_local = 0;
5994 }
5995 }
5996 }
5997 }
5998
5999 void
6000 ppc_elf_maybe_strip_sdata_syms (struct bfd_link_info *info)
6001 {
6002 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
6003
6004 if (htab != NULL)
6005 {
6006 maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[0]);
6007 maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[1]);
6008 }
6009 }
6010
6011
6012 /* Return TRUE if symbol should be hashed in the `.gnu.hash' section. */
6013
6014 static bfd_boolean
6015 ppc_elf_hash_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6016 {
6017 if (h->plt.plist != NULL
6018 && !h->def_regular
6019 && (!h->pointer_equality_needed
6020 || !h->ref_regular_nonweak))
6021 return FALSE;
6022
6023 return _bfd_elf_hash_symbol (h);
6024 }
6025 \f
6026 #define ARRAY_SIZE(a) (sizeof (a) / sizeof ((a)[0]))
6027
6028 /* Relaxation trampolines. r12 is available for clobbering (r11, is
6029 used for some functions that are allowed to break the ABI). */
6030 static const int shared_stub_entry[] =
6031 {
6032 0x7c0802a6, /* mflr 0 */
6033 0x429f0005, /* bcl 20, 31, .Lxxx */
6034 0x7d8802a6, /* mflr 12 */
6035 0x3d8c0000, /* addis 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@ha */
6036 0x398c0000, /* addi 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@l */
6037 0x7c0803a6, /* mtlr 0 */
6038 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
6039 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
6040 };
6041
6042 static const int stub_entry[] =
6043 {
6044 0x3d800000, /* lis 12,xxx@ha */
6045 0x398c0000, /* addi 12,12,xxx@l */
6046 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
6047 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
6048 };
6049
6050 struct ppc_elf_relax_info
6051 {
6052 unsigned int workaround_size;
6053 unsigned int picfixup_size;
6054 };
6055
6056 /* This function implements long branch trampolines, and the ppc476
6057 icache bug workaround. Any section needing trampolines or patch
6058 space for the workaround has its size extended so that we can
6059 add trampolines at the end of the section. */
6060
6061 static bfd_boolean
6062 ppc_elf_relax_section (bfd *abfd,
6063 asection *isec,
6064 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
6065 bfd_boolean *again)
6066 {
6067 struct one_branch_fixup
6068 {
6069 struct one_branch_fixup *next;
6070 asection *tsec;
6071 /* Final link, can use the symbol offset. For a
6072 relocatable link we use the symbol's index. */
6073 bfd_vma toff;
6074 bfd_vma trampoff;
6075 };
6076
6077 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6078 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
6079 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
6080 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs = NULL;
6081 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend = NULL;
6082 struct one_branch_fixup *branch_fixups = NULL;
6083 struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
6084 unsigned changes = 0;
6085 bfd_boolean workaround_change;
6086 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6087 bfd_size_type trampbase, trampoff, newsize, picfixup_size;
6088 asection *got2;
6089 bfd_boolean maybe_pasted;
6090
6091 *again = FALSE;
6092
6093 /* No need to do anything with non-alloc or non-code sections. */
6094 if ((isec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
6095 || (isec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0
6096 || (isec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
6097 || isec->size < 4)
6098 return TRUE;
6099
6100 /* We cannot represent the required PIC relocs in the output, so don't
6101 do anything. The linker doesn't support mixing -shared and -r
6102 anyway. */
6103 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6104 return TRUE;
6105
6106 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (link_info);
6107 if (htab == NULL)
6108 return TRUE;
6109
6110 isec->size = (isec->size + 3) & -4;
6111 if (isec->rawsize == 0)
6112 isec->rawsize = isec->size;
6113 trampbase = isec->size;
6114
6115 BFD_ASSERT (isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_NONE
6116 || isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET);
6117 isec->sec_info_type = SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET;
6118
6119 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
6120 || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6121 {
6122 if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
6123 {
6124 elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info
6125 = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_relax_info));
6126 if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
6127 return FALSE;
6128 }
6129 relax_info = elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info;
6130 trampbase -= relax_info->workaround_size;
6131 }
6132
6133 maybe_pasted = (strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
6134 || strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0);
6135 /* Space for a branch around any trampolines. */
6136 trampoff = trampbase;
6137 if (maybe_pasted && trampbase == isec->rawsize)
6138 trampoff += 4;
6139
6140 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
6141 picfixup_size = 0;
6142 if (htab->params->branch_trampolines
6143 || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6144 {
6145 /* Get a copy of the native relocations. */
6146 if (isec->reloc_count != 0)
6147 {
6148 internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, isec, NULL, NULL,
6149 link_info->keep_memory);
6150 if (internal_relocs == NULL)
6151 goto error_return;
6152 }
6153
6154 got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
6155
6156 irelend = internal_relocs + isec->reloc_count;
6157 for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
6158 {
6159 unsigned long r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
6160 bfd_vma toff, roff;
6161 asection *tsec;
6162 struct one_branch_fixup *f;
6163 size_t insn_offset = 0;
6164 bfd_vma max_branch_offset = 0, val;
6165 bfd_byte *hit_addr;
6166 unsigned long t0;
6167 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6168 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
6169 struct plt_entry **plist;
6170 unsigned char sym_type;
6171
6172 switch (r_type)
6173 {
6174 case R_PPC_REL24:
6175 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
6176 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
6177 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
6178 max_branch_offset = 1 << 25;
6179 break;
6180
6181 case R_PPC_REL14:
6182 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
6183 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
6184 max_branch_offset = 1 << 15;
6185 break;
6186
6187 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
6188 if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6189 break;
6190 continue;
6191
6192 default:
6193 continue;
6194 }
6195
6196 /* Get the value of the symbol referred to by the reloc. */
6197 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &isym, &tsec, NULL, &isymbuf,
6198 ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info), abfd))
6199 goto error_return;
6200
6201 if (isym != NULL)
6202 {
6203 if (tsec != NULL)
6204 ;
6205 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
6206 tsec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
6207 else
6208 continue;
6209
6210 toff = isym->st_value;
6211 sym_type = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info);
6212 }
6213 else
6214 {
6215 if (tsec != NULL)
6216 toff = h->root.u.def.value;
6217 else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
6218 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6219 {
6220 unsigned long indx;
6221
6222 indx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info) - symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6223 tsec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
6224 toff = bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) ? indx : 0;
6225 }
6226 else
6227 continue;
6228
6229 /* If this branch is to __tls_get_addr then we may later
6230 optimise away the call. We won't be needing a long-
6231 branch stub in that case. */
6232 if (bfd_link_executable (link_info)
6233 && h == htab->tls_get_addr
6234 && irel != internal_relocs)
6235 {
6236 unsigned long t_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel[-1].r_info);
6237 unsigned long t_rtype = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel[-1].r_info);
6238 unsigned int tls_mask = 0;
6239
6240 /* The previous reloc should be one of R_PPC_TLSGD or
6241 R_PPC_TLSLD, or for older object files, a reloc
6242 on the __tls_get_addr arg setup insn. Get tls
6243 mask bits from the symbol on that reloc. */
6244 if (t_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
6245 {
6246 bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
6247
6248 if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
6249 {
6250 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6251 (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6252 char *lgot_masks = (char *)
6253 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6254 tls_mask = lgot_masks[t_symndx];
6255 }
6256 }
6257 else
6258 {
6259 struct elf_link_hash_entry *th
6260 = elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[t_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
6261
6262 while (th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6263 || th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6264 th = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) th->root.u.i.link;
6265
6266 tls_mask
6267 = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) th)->tls_mask;
6268 }
6269
6270 /* The mask bits tell us if the call will be
6271 optimised away. */
6272 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
6273 && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSGD
6274 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16
6275 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO))
6276 continue;
6277 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
6278 && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSLD
6279 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16
6280 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO))
6281 continue;
6282 }
6283
6284 sym_type = h->type;
6285 }
6286
6287 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
6288 {
6289 if (h != NULL
6290 && !h->def_regular
6291 && h->protected_def
6292 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
6293 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo)
6294 picfixup_size += 12;
6295 continue;
6296 }
6297
6298 /* The condition here under which we call find_plt_ent must
6299 match that in relocate_section. If we call find_plt_ent here
6300 but not in relocate_section, or vice versa, then the branch
6301 destination used here may be incorrect. */
6302 plist = NULL;
6303 if (h != NULL)
6304 {
6305 /* We know is_branch_reloc (r_type) is true. */
6306 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6307 || r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6308 plist = &h->plt.plist;
6309 }
6310 else if (sym_type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6311 && elf_local_got_offsets (abfd) != NULL)
6312 {
6313 bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
6314 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6315 (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6316 plist = local_plt + ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info);
6317 }
6318 if (plist != NULL)
6319 {
6320 bfd_vma addend = 0;
6321 struct plt_entry *ent;
6322
6323 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24 && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6324 addend = irel->r_addend;
6325 ent = find_plt_ent (plist, got2, addend);
6326 if (ent != NULL)
6327 {
6328 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
6329 || h == NULL
6330 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
6331 || h->dynindx == -1)
6332 {
6333 tsec = htab->glink;
6334 toff = ent->glink_offset;
6335 }
6336 else
6337 {
6338 tsec = htab->elf.splt;
6339 toff = ent->plt.offset;
6340 }
6341 }
6342 }
6343
6344 /* If the branch and target are in the same section, you have
6345 no hope of adding stubs. We'll error out later should the
6346 branch overflow. */
6347 if (tsec == isec)
6348 continue;
6349
6350 /* toff is used for the symbol index when the symbol is
6351 undefined and we're doing a relocatable link, so we can't
6352 support addends. It would be possible to do so by
6353 putting the addend in one_branch_fixup but addends on
6354 branches are rare so it hardly seems worth supporting. */
6355 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6356 && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr
6357 && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24
6358 && irel->r_addend != 0)
6359 continue;
6360
6361 /* There probably isn't any reason to handle symbols in
6362 SEC_MERGE sections; SEC_MERGE doesn't seem a likely
6363 attribute for a code section, and we are only looking at
6364 branches. However, implement it correctly here as a
6365 reference for other target relax_section functions. */
6366 if (0 && tsec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
6367 {
6368 /* At this stage in linking, no SEC_MERGE symbol has been
6369 adjusted, so all references to such symbols need to be
6370 passed through _bfd_merged_section_offset. (Later, in
6371 relocate_section, all SEC_MERGE symbols *except* for
6372 section symbols have been adjusted.)
6373
6374 gas may reduce relocations against symbols in SEC_MERGE
6375 sections to a relocation against the section symbol when
6376 the original addend was zero. When the reloc is against
6377 a section symbol we should include the addend in the
6378 offset passed to _bfd_merged_section_offset, since the
6379 location of interest is the original symbol. On the
6380 other hand, an access to "sym+addend" where "sym" is not
6381 a section symbol should not include the addend; Such an
6382 access is presumed to be an offset from "sym"; The
6383 location of interest is just "sym". */
6384 if (sym_type == STT_SECTION
6385 && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6386 toff += irel->r_addend;
6387
6388 toff
6389 = _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, &tsec,
6390 elf_section_data (tsec)->sec_info,
6391 toff);
6392
6393 if (sym_type != STT_SECTION
6394 && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6395 toff += irel->r_addend;
6396 }
6397 /* PLTREL24 addends are special. */
6398 else if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6399 toff += irel->r_addend;
6400
6401 /* Attempted -shared link of non-pic code loses. */
6402 if ((!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6403 && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr)
6404 || tsec->output_section == NULL
6405 || (tsec->owner != NULL
6406 && (tsec->owner->flags & BFD_PLUGIN) != 0))
6407 continue;
6408
6409 roff = irel->r_offset;
6410
6411 /* Avoid creating a lot of unnecessary fixups when
6412 relocatable if the output section size is such that a
6413 fixup can be created at final link.
6414 The max_branch_offset adjustment allows for some number
6415 of other fixups being needed at final link. */
6416 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6417 && (isec->output_section->rawsize - (isec->output_offset + roff)
6418 < max_branch_offset - (max_branch_offset >> 4)))
6419 continue;
6420
6421 /* If the branch is in range, no need to do anything. */
6422 if (tsec != bfd_und_section_ptr
6423 && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6424 /* A relocatable link may have sections moved during
6425 final link, so do not presume they remain in range. */
6426 || tsec->output_section == isec->output_section))
6427 {
6428 bfd_vma symaddr, reladdr;
6429
6430 symaddr = tsec->output_section->vma + tsec->output_offset + toff;
6431 reladdr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset + roff;
6432 if (symaddr - reladdr + max_branch_offset
6433 < 2 * max_branch_offset)
6434 continue;
6435 }
6436
6437 /* Look for an existing fixup to this address. */
6438 for (f = branch_fixups; f ; f = f->next)
6439 if (f->tsec == tsec && f->toff == toff)
6440 break;
6441
6442 if (f == NULL)
6443 {
6444 size_t size;
6445 unsigned long stub_rtype;
6446
6447 val = trampoff - roff;
6448 if (val >= max_branch_offset)
6449 /* Oh dear, we can't reach a trampoline. Don't try to add
6450 one. We'll report an error later. */
6451 continue;
6452
6453 if (bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6454 {
6455 size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry);
6456 insn_offset = 12;
6457 }
6458 else
6459 {
6460 size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
6461 insn_offset = 0;
6462 }
6463 stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX;
6464 if (tsec == htab->elf.splt
6465 || tsec == htab->glink)
6466 {
6467 stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLT;
6468 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6469 stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24;
6470 }
6471
6472 /* Hijack the old relocation. Since we need two
6473 relocations for this use a "composite" reloc. */
6474 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info),
6475 stub_rtype);
6476 irel->r_offset = trampoff + insn_offset;
6477 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
6478 && stub_rtype != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
6479 irel->r_addend = 0;
6480
6481 /* Record the fixup so we don't do it again this section. */
6482 f = bfd_malloc (sizeof (*f));
6483 f->next = branch_fixups;
6484 f->tsec = tsec;
6485 f->toff = toff;
6486 f->trampoff = trampoff;
6487 branch_fixups = f;
6488
6489 trampoff += size;
6490 changes++;
6491 }
6492 else
6493 {
6494 val = f->trampoff - roff;
6495 if (val >= max_branch_offset)
6496 continue;
6497
6498 /* Nop out the reloc, since we're finalizing things here. */
6499 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
6500 }
6501
6502 /* Get the section contents. */
6503 if (contents == NULL)
6504 {
6505 /* Get cached copy if it exists. */
6506 if (elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
6507 contents = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents;
6508 /* Go get them off disk. */
6509 else if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, isec, &contents))
6510 goto error_return;
6511 }
6512
6513 /* Fix up the existing branch to hit the trampoline. */
6514 hit_addr = contents + roff;
6515 switch (r_type)
6516 {
6517 case R_PPC_REL24:
6518 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
6519 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
6520 t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
6521 t0 &= ~0x3fffffc;
6522 t0 |= val & 0x3fffffc;
6523 bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
6524 break;
6525
6526 case R_PPC_REL14:
6527 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
6528 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
6529 t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
6530 t0 &= ~0xfffc;
6531 t0 |= val & 0xfffc;
6532 bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
6533 break;
6534 }
6535 }
6536
6537 while (branch_fixups != NULL)
6538 {
6539 struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
6540 branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
6541 free (f);
6542 }
6543 }
6544
6545 workaround_change = FALSE;
6546 newsize = trampoff;
6547 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
6548 && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6549 || isec->output_section->alignment_power >= htab->params->pagesize_p2))
6550 {
6551 bfd_vma addr, end_addr;
6552 unsigned int crossings;
6553 bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
6554
6555 addr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset;
6556 end_addr = addr + trampoff;
6557 addr &= -pagesize;
6558 crossings = ((end_addr & -pagesize) - addr) >> htab->params->pagesize_p2;
6559 if (crossings != 0)
6560 {
6561 /* Keep space aligned, to ensure the patch code itself does
6562 not cross a page. Don't decrease size calculated on a
6563 previous pass as otherwise we might never settle on a layout. */
6564 newsize = 15 - ((end_addr - 1) & 15);
6565 newsize += crossings * 16;
6566 if (relax_info->workaround_size < newsize)
6567 {
6568 relax_info->workaround_size = newsize;
6569 workaround_change = TRUE;
6570 }
6571 /* Ensure relocate_section is called. */
6572 isec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
6573 }
6574 newsize = trampoff + relax_info->workaround_size;
6575 }
6576
6577 if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6578 {
6579 picfixup_size -= relax_info->picfixup_size;
6580 if (picfixup_size != 0)
6581 relax_info->picfixup_size += picfixup_size;
6582 newsize += relax_info->picfixup_size;
6583 }
6584
6585 if (changes != 0 || picfixup_size != 0 || workaround_change)
6586 isec->size = newsize;
6587
6588 if (isymbuf != NULL
6589 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) isymbuf)
6590 {
6591 if (! link_info->keep_memory)
6592 free (isymbuf);
6593 else
6594 {
6595 /* Cache the symbols for elf_link_input_bfd. */
6596 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) isymbuf;
6597 }
6598 }
6599
6600 if (contents != NULL
6601 && elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6602 {
6603 if (!changes && !link_info->keep_memory)
6604 free (contents);
6605 else
6606 {
6607 /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd. */
6608 elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
6609 }
6610 }
6611
6612 changes += picfixup_size;
6613 if (changes != 0)
6614 {
6615 /* Append sufficient NOP relocs so we can write out relocation
6616 information for the trampolines. */
6617 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
6618 Elf_Internal_Rela *new_relocs = bfd_malloc ((changes + isec->reloc_count)
6619 * sizeof (*new_relocs));
6620 unsigned ix;
6621
6622 if (!new_relocs)
6623 goto error_return;
6624 memcpy (new_relocs, internal_relocs,
6625 isec->reloc_count * sizeof (*new_relocs));
6626 for (ix = changes; ix--;)
6627 {
6628 irel = new_relocs + ix + isec->reloc_count;
6629
6630 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
6631 }
6632 if (internal_relocs != elf_section_data (isec)->relocs)
6633 free (internal_relocs);
6634 elf_section_data (isec)->relocs = new_relocs;
6635 isec->reloc_count += changes;
6636 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (isec);
6637 rel_hdr->sh_size += changes * rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
6638 }
6639 else if (internal_relocs != NULL
6640 && elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6641 free (internal_relocs);
6642
6643 *again = changes != 0 || workaround_change;
6644 return TRUE;
6645
6646 error_return:
6647 while (branch_fixups != NULL)
6648 {
6649 struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
6650 branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
6651 free (f);
6652 }
6653 if (isymbuf != NULL && (unsigned char *) isymbuf != symtab_hdr->contents)
6654 free (isymbuf);
6655 if (contents != NULL
6656 && elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6657 free (contents);
6658 if (internal_relocs != NULL
6659 && elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6660 free (internal_relocs);
6661 return FALSE;
6662 }
6663 \f
6664 /* What to do when ld finds relocations against symbols defined in
6665 discarded sections. */
6666
6667 static unsigned int
6668 ppc_elf_action_discarded (asection *sec)
6669 {
6670 if (strcmp (".fixup", sec->name) == 0)
6671 return 0;
6672
6673 if (strcmp (".got2", sec->name) == 0)
6674 return 0;
6675
6676 return _bfd_elf_default_action_discarded (sec);
6677 }
6678 \f
6679 /* Fill in the address for a pointer generated in a linker section. */
6680
6681 static bfd_vma
6682 elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (bfd *input_bfd,
6683 elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
6684 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
6685 bfd_vma relocation,
6686 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
6687 {
6688 elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
6689
6690 BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
6691
6692 if (h != NULL)
6693 {
6694 /* Handle global symbol. */
6695 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
6696
6697 eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6698 BFD_ASSERT (eh->elf.def_regular);
6699 linker_section_ptr = eh->linker_section_pointer;
6700 }
6701 else
6702 {
6703 /* Handle local symbol. */
6704 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
6705
6706 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (input_bfd));
6707 BFD_ASSERT (elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd) != NULL);
6708 linker_section_ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd)[r_symndx];
6709 }
6710
6711 linker_section_ptr = elf_find_pointer_linker_section (linker_section_ptr,
6712 rel->r_addend,
6713 lsect);
6714 BFD_ASSERT (linker_section_ptr != NULL);
6715
6716 /* Offset will always be a multiple of four, so use the bottom bit
6717 as a "written" flag. */
6718 if ((linker_section_ptr->offset & 1) == 0)
6719 {
6720 bfd_put_32 (lsect->section->owner,
6721 relocation + linker_section_ptr->addend,
6722 lsect->section->contents + linker_section_ptr->offset);
6723 linker_section_ptr->offset += 1;
6724 }
6725
6726 relocation = (lsect->section->output_section->vma
6727 + lsect->section->output_offset
6728 + linker_section_ptr->offset - 1
6729 - SYM_VAL (lsect->sym));
6730
6731 #ifdef DEBUG
6732 fprintf (stderr,
6733 "Finish pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld (0x%lx)\n",
6734 lsect->name, (long) relocation, (long) relocation);
6735 #endif
6736
6737 return relocation;
6738 }
6739
6740 #define PPC_LO(v) ((v) & 0xffff)
6741 #define PPC_HI(v) (((v) >> 16) & 0xffff)
6742 #define PPC_HA(v) PPC_HI ((v) + 0x8000)
6743
6744 static void
6745 write_glink_stub (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, struct plt_entry *ent,
6746 asection *plt_sec, unsigned char *p,
6747 struct bfd_link_info *info)
6748 {
6749 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
6750 bfd *output_bfd = info->output_bfd;
6751 bfd_vma plt;
6752 unsigned char *end = p + GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
6753
6754 if (h != NULL
6755 && h == htab->tls_get_addr
6756 && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
6757 {
6758 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_3, p);
6759 p += 4;
6760 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_3 + 4, p);
6761 p += 4;
6762 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_0_3, p);
6763 p += 4;
6764 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, CMPWI_11_0, p);
6765 p += 4;
6766 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_3_12_2, p);
6767 p += 4;
6768 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BEQLR, p);
6769 p += 4;
6770 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_3_0, p);
6771 p += 4;
6772 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
6773 p += 4;
6774 }
6775
6776 plt = ((ent->plt.offset & ~1)
6777 + plt_sec->output_section->vma
6778 + plt_sec->output_offset);
6779
6780 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
6781 {
6782 bfd_vma got = 0;
6783
6784 if (ent->addend >= 32768)
6785 got = (ent->addend
6786 + ent->sec->output_section->vma
6787 + ent->sec->output_offset);
6788 else if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
6789 got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
6790
6791 plt -= got;
6792
6793 if (plt + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
6794 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_30 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6795 else
6796 {
6797 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_30 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
6798 p += 4;
6799 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6800 }
6801 }
6802 else
6803 {
6804 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_11 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
6805 p += 4;
6806 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6807 }
6808 p += 4;
6809 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_11, p);
6810 p += 4;
6811 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
6812 p += 4;
6813 while (p < end)
6814 {
6815 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
6816 p += 4;
6817 }
6818 }
6819
6820 /* Return true if symbol is defined statically. */
6821
6822 static bfd_boolean
6823 is_static_defined (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6824 {
6825 return ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6826 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6827 && h->root.u.def.section != NULL
6828 && h->root.u.def.section->output_section != NULL);
6829 }
6830
6831 /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tls operand, return
6832 the transformed insn for TLS optimisation, otherwise return 0. If
6833 REG is non-zero only match an insn with RB or RA equal to REG. */
6834
6835 unsigned int
6836 _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
6837 {
6838 unsigned int rtra;
6839
6840 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) != 31 << 26)
6841 return 0;
6842
6843 if (reg == 0 || ((insn >> 11) & 0x1f) == reg)
6844 rtra = insn & ((1 << 26) - (1 << 16));
6845 else if (((insn >> 16) & 0x1f) == reg)
6846 rtra = (insn & (0x1f << 21)) | ((insn & (0x1f << 11)) << 5);
6847 else
6848 return 0;
6849
6850 if ((insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == 266 << 1)
6851 /* add -> addi. */
6852 insn = 14 << 26;
6853 else if ((insn & (0x1f << 1)) == 23 << 1
6854 && ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 14 << 6
6855 || ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) >= 16 << 6
6856 && (insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 24 << 6)))
6857 /* load and store indexed -> dform. */
6858 insn = (32 | ((insn >> 6) & 0x1f)) << 26;
6859 else if ((insn & (((0x1a << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 21 << 1)
6860 /* ldx, ldux, stdx, stdux -> ld, ldu, std, stdu. */
6861 insn = ((58 | ((insn >> 6) & 4)) << 26) | ((insn >> 6) & 1);
6862 else if ((insn & (((0x1f << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 341 << 1)
6863 /* lwax -> lwa. */
6864 insn = (58 << 26) | 2;
6865 else
6866 return 0;
6867 insn |= rtra;
6868 return insn;
6869 }
6870
6871 /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tprel operand, return
6872 the transformed insn for an undefined weak symbol, ie. with the
6873 thread pointer REG operand removed. Otherwise return 0. */
6874
6875 unsigned int
6876 _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
6877 {
6878 if ((insn & (0x1f << 16)) == reg << 16
6879 && ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
6880 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 15u << 26 /* addis */
6881 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
6882 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
6883 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
6884 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
6885 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
6886 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
6887 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
6888 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
6889 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
6890 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
6891 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
6892 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
6893 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
6894 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
6895 && (insn & 3) != 1)
6896 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
6897 && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3))))
6898 {
6899 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
6900 }
6901 else if ((insn & (0x1f << 21)) == reg << 21
6902 && ((insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori, oris */
6903 || (insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */
6904 || (insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi,andis */))
6905 {
6906 insn &= ~(0x1f << 21);
6907 insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 16)) << 5;
6908 if ((insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 26 << 26 /* xori,xoris */)
6909 insn -= 2 >> 26; /* convert to ori,oris */
6910 }
6911 else
6912 insn = 0;
6913 return insn;
6914 }
6915
6916 static bfd_boolean
6917 is_insn_ds_form (unsigned int insn)
6918 {
6919 return ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* ld,ldu,lwa */
6920 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std,stdu,stq */
6921 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 57u << 26 /* lfdp */
6922 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 61u << 26 /* stfdp */);
6923 }
6924
6925 static bfd_boolean
6926 is_insn_dq_form (unsigned int insn)
6927 {
6928 return ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 56u << 26 /* lq */
6929 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (61u << 26) /* lxv, stxv */
6930 && (insn & 3) == 1));
6931 }
6932
6933 /* The RELOCATE_SECTION function is called by the ELF backend linker
6934 to handle the relocations for a section.
6935
6936 The relocs are always passed as Rela structures; if the section
6937 actually uses Rel structures, the r_addend field will always be
6938 zero.
6939
6940 This function is responsible for adjust the section contents as
6941 necessary, and (if using Rela relocs and generating a
6942 relocatable output file) adjusting the reloc addend as
6943 necessary.
6944
6945 This function does not have to worry about setting the reloc
6946 address or the reloc symbol index.
6947
6948 LOCAL_SYMS is a pointer to the swapped in local symbols.
6949
6950 LOCAL_SECTIONS is an array giving the section in the input file
6951 corresponding to the st_shndx field of each local symbol.
6952
6953 The global hash table entry for the global symbols can be found
6954 via elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd).
6955
6956 When generating relocatable output, this function must handle
6957 STB_LOCAL/STT_SECTION symbols specially. The output symbol is
6958 going to be the section symbol corresponding to the output
6959 section, which means that the addend must be adjusted
6960 accordingly. */
6961
6962 static bfd_boolean
6963 ppc_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd,
6964 struct bfd_link_info *info,
6965 bfd *input_bfd,
6966 asection *input_section,
6967 bfd_byte *contents,
6968 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
6969 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
6970 asection **local_sections)
6971 {
6972 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6973 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
6974 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6975 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
6976 Elf_Internal_Rela *wrel;
6977 Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
6978 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
6979 asection *got2;
6980 bfd_vma *local_got_offsets;
6981 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
6982 bfd_vma d_offset = (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd) ? 2 : 0);
6983 bfd_boolean is_vxworks_tls;
6984 unsigned int picfixup_size = 0;
6985 struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
6986
6987 #ifdef DEBUG
6988 _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_relocate_section called for %pB section %pA, "
6989 "%ld relocations%s",
6990 input_bfd, input_section,
6991 (long) input_section->reloc_count,
6992 (bfd_link_relocatable (info)) ? " (relocatable)" : "");
6993 #endif
6994
6995 if (!is_ppc_elf (input_bfd))
6996 {
6997 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
6998 return FALSE;
6999 }
7000
7001 got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (input_bfd, ".got2");
7002
7003 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
7004 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
7005 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
7006
7007 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
7008 local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (input_bfd);
7009 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd);
7010 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd);
7011 /* We have to handle relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections
7012 specially, because the dynamic loader is 'weird'. */
7013 is_vxworks_tls = (htab->is_vxworks && bfd_link_pic (info)
7014 && !strcmp (input_section->output_section->name,
7015 ".tls_vars"));
7016 if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET)
7017 relax_info = elf_section_data (input_section)->sec_info;
7018 rel = wrel = relocs;
7019 relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count;
7020 for (; rel < relend; wrel++, rel++)
7021 {
7022 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
7023 bfd_vma addend;
7024 bfd_reloc_status_type r;
7025 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7026 asection *sec;
7027 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7028 const char *sym_name;
7029 reloc_howto_type *howto;
7030 unsigned long r_symndx;
7031 bfd_vma relocation;
7032 bfd_vma branch_bit, from;
7033 bfd_boolean unresolved_reloc, save_unresolved_reloc;
7034 bfd_boolean warned;
7035 unsigned int tls_type, tls_mask, tls_gd;
7036 struct plt_entry **ifunc, **plt_list;
7037 struct reloc_howto_struct alt_howto;
7038
7039 again:
7040 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
7041 sym = NULL;
7042 sec = NULL;
7043 h = NULL;
7044 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7045 warned = FALSE;
7046 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7047
7048 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7049 {
7050 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
7051 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
7052 sym_name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr, sym, sec);
7053
7054 relocation = _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
7055 }
7056 else
7057 {
7058 bfd_boolean ignored;
7059
7060 RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL (info, input_bfd, input_section, rel,
7061 r_symndx, symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
7062 h, sec, relocation,
7063 unresolved_reloc, warned, ignored);
7064
7065 sym_name = h->root.root.string;
7066 }
7067
7068 if (sec != NULL && discarded_section (sec))
7069 {
7070 /* For relocs against symbols from removed linkonce sections,
7071 or sections discarded by a linker script, we just want the
7072 section contents zeroed. Avoid any special processing. */
7073 howto = NULL;
7074 if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
7075 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
7076
7077 _bfd_clear_contents (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
7078 contents, rel->r_offset);
7079 wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset;
7080 wrel->r_info = 0;
7081 wrel->r_addend = 0;
7082
7083 /* For ld -r, remove relocations in debug sections against
7084 symbols defined in discarded sections. Not done for
7085 non-debug to preserve relocs in .eh_frame which the
7086 eh_frame editing code expects to be present. */
7087 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info)
7088 && (input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING))
7089 wrel--;
7090
7091 continue;
7092 }
7093
7094 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
7095 {
7096 if (got2 != NULL
7097 && r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
7098 && rel->r_addend != 0)
7099 {
7100 /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special. If non-zero, the
7101 addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2. */
7102 rel->r_addend += got2->output_offset;
7103 }
7104 if (r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLT
7105 && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24
7106 && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX)
7107 goto copy_reloc;
7108 }
7109
7110 /* TLS optimizations. Replace instruction sequences and relocs
7111 based on information we collected in tls_optimize. We edit
7112 RELOCS so that --emit-relocs will output something sensible
7113 for the final instruction stream. */
7114 tls_mask = 0;
7115 tls_gd = 0;
7116 if (h != NULL)
7117 tls_mask = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->tls_mask;
7118 else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
7119 {
7120 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
7121 char *lgot_masks;
7122 local_plt
7123 = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7124 lgot_masks = (char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7125 tls_mask = lgot_masks[r_symndx];
7126 }
7127
7128 /* Ensure reloc mapping code below stays sane. */
7129 if ((R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)
7130 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO & 3)
7131 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI & 3)
7132 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA & 3)
7133 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16 & 3)
7134 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO & 3)
7135 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI & 3)
7136 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA & 3))
7137 abort ();
7138 switch (r_type)
7139 {
7140 default:
7141 break;
7142
7143 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
7144 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
7145 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7146 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
7147 {
7148 bfd_vma insn;
7149
7150 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7151 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7152 insn &= 31 << 21;
7153 insn |= 0x3c020000; /* addis 0,2,0 */
7154 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
7155 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7156 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
7157 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7158 }
7159 break;
7160
7161 case R_PPC_TLS:
7162 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7163 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
7164 {
7165 bfd_vma insn;
7166
7167 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7168 insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (insn, 2);
7169 if (insn == 0)
7170 abort ();
7171 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
7172 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
7173 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7174
7175 /* Was PPC_TLS which sits on insn boundary, now
7176 PPC_TPREL16_LO which is at low-order half-word. */
7177 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7178 }
7179 break;
7180
7181 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7182 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7183 tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
7184 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
7185 goto tls_gdld_hi;
7186 break;
7187
7188 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7189 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7190 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
7191 {
7192 tls_gdld_hi:
7193 if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
7194 r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
7195 + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
7196 else
7197 {
7198 rel->r_offset -= d_offset;
7199 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
7200 r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
7201 }
7202 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7203 }
7204 break;
7205
7206 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
7207 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7208 tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
7209 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
7210 goto tls_ldgd_opt;
7211 break;
7212
7213 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
7214 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7215 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
7216 {
7217 unsigned int insn1, insn2;
7218 bfd_vma offset;
7219
7220 tls_ldgd_opt:
7221 offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
7222 /* If not using the newer R_PPC_TLSGD/LD to mark
7223 __tls_get_addr calls, we must trust that the call
7224 stays with its arg setup insns, ie. that the next
7225 reloc is the __tls_get_addr call associated with
7226 the current reloc. Edit both insns. */
7227 if (input_section->has_tls_get_addr_call
7228 && rel + 1 < relend
7229 && branch_reloc_hash_match (input_bfd, rel + 1,
7230 htab->tls_get_addr))
7231 offset = rel[1].r_offset;
7232 /* We read the low GOT_TLS insn because we need to keep
7233 the destination reg. It may be something other than
7234 the usual r3, and moved to r3 before the call by
7235 intervening code. */
7236 insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7237 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7238 if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
7239 {
7240 /* IE */
7241 insn1 &= (0x1f << 21) | (0x1f << 16);
7242 insn1 |= 32 << 26; /* lwz */
7243 if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
7244 {
7245 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7246 insn2 = 0x7c631214; /* add 3,3,2 */
7247 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7248 }
7249 r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
7250 + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
7251 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7252 }
7253 else
7254 {
7255 /* LE */
7256 insn1 &= 0x1f << 21;
7257 insn1 |= 0x3c020000; /* addis r,2,0 */
7258 if (tls_gd == 0)
7259 {
7260 /* Was an LD reloc. */
7261 for (r_symndx = 0;
7262 r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7263 r_symndx++)
7264 if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
7265 break;
7266 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7267 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7268 rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7269 if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
7270 rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
7271 + sec->output_offset
7272 + sec->output_section->vma);
7273 }
7274 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
7275 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7276 if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
7277 {
7278 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
7279 rel[1].r_offset = offset + d_offset;
7280 rel[1].r_addend = rel->r_addend;
7281 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7282 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7283 }
7284 }
7285 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn1,
7286 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7287 if (tls_gd == 0)
7288 {
7289 /* We changed the symbol on an LD reloc. Start over
7290 in order to get h, sym, sec etc. right. */
7291 goto again;
7292 }
7293 }
7294 break;
7295
7296 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
7297 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
7298 && rel + 1 < relend)
7299 {
7300 unsigned int insn2;
7301 bfd_vma offset = rel->r_offset;
7302
7303 if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7304 {
7305 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + offset);
7306 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7307 break;
7308 }
7309
7310 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) != 0)
7311 {
7312 /* IE */
7313 r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
7314 insn2 = 0x7c631214; /* add 3,3,2 */
7315 }
7316 else
7317 {
7318 /* LE */
7319 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
7320 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7321 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7322 }
7323 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7324 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7325 /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
7326 BFD_ASSERT (offset == rel[1].r_offset);
7327 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7328 }
7329 break;
7330
7331 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
7332 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
7333 && rel + 1 < relend)
7334 {
7335 unsigned int insn2;
7336
7337 if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7338 {
7339 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
7340 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7341 break;
7342 }
7343
7344 for (r_symndx = 0;
7345 r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7346 r_symndx++)
7347 if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
7348 break;
7349 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7350 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7351 rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7352 if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
7353 rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
7354 + sec->output_offset
7355 + sec->output_section->vma);
7356
7357 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
7358 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7359 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7360 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2,
7361 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7362 /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
7363 BFD_ASSERT (rel->r_offset - d_offset == rel[1].r_offset);
7364 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7365 goto again;
7366 }
7367 break;
7368 }
7369
7370 /* Handle other relocations that tweak non-addend part of insn. */
7371 branch_bit = 0;
7372 switch (r_type)
7373 {
7374 default:
7375 break;
7376
7377 /* Branch taken prediction relocations. */
7378 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
7379 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
7380 branch_bit = BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7381 /* Fall through. */
7382
7383 /* Branch not taken prediction relocations. */
7384 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
7385 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
7386 {
7387 unsigned int insn;
7388
7389 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7390 insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7391 insn |= branch_bit;
7392
7393 from = (rel->r_offset
7394 + input_section->output_offset
7395 + input_section->output_section->vma);
7396
7397 /* Invert 'y' bit if not the default. */
7398 if ((bfd_signed_vma) (relocation + rel->r_addend - from) < 0)
7399 insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7400
7401 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
7402 }
7403 break;
7404
7405 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
7406 {
7407 unsigned int insn;
7408
7409 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7410 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7411 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 15u << 26
7412 && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) != 0)
7413 {
7414 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
7415 {
7416 /* Convert addis to lis. */
7417 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
7418 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
7419 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7420 }
7421 }
7422 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
7423 info->callbacks->einfo
7424 (_("%P: %H: error: %s with unexpected instruction %x\n"),
7425 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7426 "R_PPC_PLT16_HA", insn);
7427 }
7428 break;
7429 }
7430
7431 if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
7432 && h != NULL
7433 && !h->def_regular
7434 && h->protected_def
7435 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
7436 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
7437 && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
7438 {
7439 /* Convert lis;addi or lis;load/store accessing a protected
7440 variable defined in a shared library to PIC. */
7441 unsigned int insn;
7442
7443 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
7444 {
7445 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7446 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7447 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (15u << 26)
7448 && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) == 0 /* lis */)
7449 {
7450 bfd_byte *p;
7451 bfd_vma off;
7452 bfd_vma got_addr;
7453
7454 p = (contents + input_section->size
7455 - relax_info->workaround_size
7456 - relax_info->picfixup_size
7457 + picfixup_size);
7458 off = (p - contents) - (rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7459 if (off > 0x1fffffc || (off & 3) != 0)
7460 info->callbacks->einfo
7461 (_("%H: fixup branch overflow\n"),
7462 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
7463
7464 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | off,
7465 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7466 got_addr = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7467 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7468 + (h->got.offset & ~1));
7469 wrel->r_offset = (p - contents) + d_offset;
7470 wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
7471 wrel->r_addend = got_addr;
7472 insn &= ~0xffff;
7473 insn |= ((unsigned int) (got_addr + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
7474 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
7475
7476 /* Convert lis to lwz, loading address from GOT. */
7477 insn &= ~0xffff;
7478 insn ^= (32u ^ 15u) << 26;
7479 insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 21)) >> 5;
7480 insn |= got_addr & 0xffff;
7481 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p + 4);
7482
7483 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | ((-4 - off) & 0x3ffffff), p + 8);
7484 picfixup_size += 12;
7485
7486 /* Use one of the spare relocs, so --emit-relocs
7487 output is reasonable. */
7488 memmove (rel + 1, rel, (relend - rel - 1) * sizeof (*rel));
7489 wrel++, rel++;
7490 rel->r_offset = wrel[-1].r_offset + 4;
7491 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
7492 rel->r_addend = wrel[-1].r_addend;
7493
7494 /* Continue on as if we had a got reloc, to output
7495 dynamic reloc. */
7496 r_type = R_PPC_GOT16_LO;
7497 }
7498 else
7499 _bfd_error_handler
7500 /* xgettext:c-format */
7501 (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
7502 "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
7503 input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
7504 "R_PPC_ADDR16_HA", insn);
7505 }
7506 else if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
7507 {
7508 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7509 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7510 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
7511 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
7512 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
7513 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
7514 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
7515 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
7516 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
7517 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
7518 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
7519 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
7520 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
7521 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
7522 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
7523 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
7524 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
7525 && (insn & 3) != 1)
7526 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
7527 && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3)))
7528 {
7529 /* Arrange to apply the reloc addend, if any. */
7530 relocation = 0;
7531 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7532 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, r_type);
7533 }
7534 else
7535 _bfd_error_handler
7536 /* xgettext:c-format */
7537 (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
7538 "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
7539 input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
7540 "R_PPC_ADDR16_LO", insn);
7541 }
7542 }
7543
7544 ifunc = NULL;
7545 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
7546 {
7547 struct plt_entry *ent;
7548
7549 if (h != NULL)
7550 {
7551 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
7552 ifunc = &h->plt.plist;
7553 }
7554 else if (local_got_offsets != NULL
7555 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
7556 {
7557 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
7558
7559 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
7560 + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7561 ifunc = local_plt + r_symndx;
7562 }
7563
7564 ent = NULL;
7565 if (ifunc != NULL
7566 && (!bfd_link_pic (info)
7567 || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
7568 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
7569 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
7570 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
7571 {
7572 addend = 0;
7573 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
7574 && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
7575 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
7576 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
7577 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
7578 addend = rel->r_addend;
7579 ent = find_plt_ent (ifunc, got2, addend);
7580 }
7581 if (ent != NULL)
7582 {
7583 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
7584 && ent->sec != got2
7585 && htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW
7586 && (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7587 || h == NULL
7588 || h->dynindx == -1))
7589 {
7590 /* Uh oh, we are going to create a pic glink stub
7591 for an ifunc (here for h == NULL and later in
7592 finish_dynamic_symbol for h != NULL), and
7593 apparently are using code compiled with
7594 -mbss-plt. The difficulty is that -mbss-plt code
7595 gives no indication via a magic PLTREL24 addend
7596 whether r30 is equal to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or
7597 is pointing into a .got2 section (and how far
7598 into .got2). */
7599 info->callbacks->einfo
7600 /* xgettext:c-format */
7601 (_("%X%H: unsupported bss-plt -fPIC ifunc %s\n"),
7602 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, sym_name);
7603 }
7604
7605 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7606 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
7607 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7608 || h == NULL
7609 || h->dynindx == -1)
7610 relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
7611 + htab->glink->output_offset
7612 + (ent->glink_offset & ~1));
7613 else
7614 relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
7615 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
7616 + ent->plt.offset);
7617 }
7618 }
7619
7620 addend = rel->r_addend;
7621 save_unresolved_reloc = unresolved_reloc;
7622 howto = NULL;
7623 if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
7624 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
7625
7626 switch (r_type)
7627 {
7628 default:
7629 break;
7630
7631 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
7632 if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
7633 {
7634 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
7635 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
7636 if ((insn & ((0x3f << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
7637 != ((15u << 26) | (2 << 16)) /* addis rt,2,imm */)
7638 /* xgettext:c-format */
7639 info->callbacks->minfo
7640 (_("%H: warning: %s unexpected insn %#x.\n"),
7641 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, howto->name, insn);
7642 else
7643 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
7644 }
7645 break;
7646
7647 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
7648 if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
7649 {
7650 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
7651 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
7652 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
7653 insn |= 2 << 16;
7654 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
7655 }
7656 break;
7657 }
7658
7659 tls_type = 0;
7660 switch (r_type)
7661 {
7662 default:
7663 /* xgettext:c-format */
7664 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
7665 input_bfd, howto->name);
7666
7667 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7668 ret = FALSE;
7669 goto copy_reloc;
7670
7671 case R_PPC_NONE:
7672 case R_PPC_TLS:
7673 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
7674 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
7675 case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
7676 case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
7677 case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
7678 goto copy_reloc;
7679
7680 /* GOT16 relocations. Like an ADDR16 using the symbol's
7681 address in the GOT as relocation value instead of the
7682 symbol's value itself. Also, create a GOT entry for the
7683 symbol and put the symbol value there. */
7684 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
7685 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7686 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7687 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7688 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7689 goto dogot;
7690
7691 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
7692 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7693 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7694 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7695 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7696 goto dogot;
7697
7698 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
7699 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
7700 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
7701 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
7702 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7703 goto dogot;
7704
7705 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
7706 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
7707 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
7708 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
7709 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
7710 goto dogot;
7711
7712 case R_PPC_GOT16:
7713 case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
7714 case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
7715 case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
7716 tls_mask = 0;
7717 dogot:
7718 {
7719 /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the global
7720 offset table. */
7721 bfd_vma off;
7722 bfd_vma *offp;
7723 unsigned long indx;
7724
7725 if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
7726 abort ();
7727
7728 indx = 0;
7729 if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
7730 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7731 offp = &htab->tlsld_got.offset;
7732 else if (h != NULL)
7733 {
7734 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7735 || h->dynindx == -1
7736 || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)
7737 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
7738 /* This is actually a static link, or it is a
7739 -Bsymbolic link and the symbol is defined
7740 locally, or the symbol was forced to be local
7741 because of a version file. */
7742 ;
7743 else
7744 {
7745 indx = h->dynindx;
7746 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7747 }
7748 offp = &h->got.offset;
7749 }
7750 else
7751 {
7752 if (local_got_offsets == NULL)
7753 abort ();
7754 offp = &local_got_offsets[r_symndx];
7755 }
7756
7757 /* The offset must always be a multiple of 4. We use the
7758 least significant bit to record whether we have already
7759 processed this entry. */
7760 off = *offp;
7761 if ((off & 1) != 0)
7762 off &= ~1;
7763 else
7764 {
7765 unsigned int tls_m = ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7766 ? tls_mask & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL
7767 | TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)
7768 : 0);
7769
7770 if (offp == &htab->tlsld_got.offset)
7771 tls_m = TLS_LD;
7772 else if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0
7773 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7774 tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
7775
7776 /* We might have multiple got entries for this sym.
7777 Initialize them all. */
7778 do
7779 {
7780 int tls_ty = 0;
7781
7782 if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0)
7783 {
7784 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7785 tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
7786 }
7787 else if ((tls_m & TLS_GD) != 0)
7788 {
7789 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7790 tls_m &= ~TLS_GD;
7791 }
7792 else if ((tls_m & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
7793 {
7794 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
7795 tls_m &= ~TLS_DTPREL;
7796 }
7797 else if ((tls_m & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
7798 {
7799 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7800 tls_m = 0;
7801 }
7802
7803 /* Generate relocs for the dynamic linker. */
7804 if (indx != 0
7805 || (bfd_link_pic (info)
7806 && (h == NULL
7807 || !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
7808 && !(tls_ty != 0
7809 && bfd_link_executable (info)
7810 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))))
7811 {
7812 asection *rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
7813 bfd_byte * loc;
7814
7815 if (ifunc != NULL)
7816 {
7817 rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
7818 if (indx == 0)
7819 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
7820 else if (is_static_defined (h))
7821 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
7822 }
7823 outrel.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7824 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7825 + off);
7826 outrel.r_addend = 0;
7827 if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7828 {
7829 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPMOD32);
7830 if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
7831 {
7832 loc = rsec->contents;
7833 loc += (rsec->reloc_count++
7834 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
7835 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd,
7836 &outrel, loc);
7837 outrel.r_offset += 4;
7838 outrel.r_info
7839 = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
7840 }
7841 }
7842 else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
7843 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
7844 else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL))
7845 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_TPREL32);
7846 else if (indx != 0)
7847 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_GLOB_DAT);
7848 else if (ifunc != NULL)
7849 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
7850 else
7851 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
7852 if (indx == 0 && tls_ty != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
7853 {
7854 outrel.r_addend += relocation;
7855 if (tls_ty & (TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL | TLS_TPREL))
7856 {
7857 if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
7858 outrel.r_addend = 0;
7859 else
7860 outrel.r_addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma;
7861 }
7862 }
7863 loc = rsec->contents;
7864 loc += (rsec->reloc_count++
7865 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
7866 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
7867 }
7868
7869 /* Init the .got section contents if we're not
7870 emitting a reloc. */
7871 else
7872 {
7873 bfd_vma value = relocation;
7874
7875 if (tls_ty != 0)
7876 {
7877 if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
7878 value = 0;
7879 else
7880 {
7881 if (tls_ty & TLS_LD)
7882 value = 0;
7883 else
7884 value -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7885 if (tls_ty & TLS_TPREL)
7886 value += DTP_OFFSET - TP_OFFSET;
7887 }
7888
7889 if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7890 {
7891 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
7892 htab->elf.sgot->contents + off + 4);
7893 value = 1;
7894 }
7895 }
7896 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
7897 htab->elf.sgot->contents + off);
7898 }
7899
7900 off += 4;
7901 if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7902 off += 4;
7903 }
7904 while (tls_m != 0);
7905
7906 off = *offp;
7907 *offp = off | 1;
7908 }
7909
7910 if (off >= (bfd_vma) -2)
7911 abort ();
7912
7913 if ((tls_type & TLS_TLS) != 0)
7914 {
7915 if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
7916 {
7917 if ((tls_mask & TLS_LD) != 0
7918 && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7919 off += 8;
7920 if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
7921 {
7922 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
7923 off += 8;
7924 if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
7925 {
7926 if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
7927 off += 4;
7928 }
7929 }
7930 }
7931 }
7932
7933 /* If here for a picfixup, we're done. */
7934 if (r_type != ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
7935 goto copy_reloc;
7936
7937 relocation = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7938 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7939 + off
7940 - SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot));
7941
7942 /* Addends on got relocations don't make much sense.
7943 x+off@got is actually x@got+off, and since the got is
7944 generated by a hash table traversal, the value in the
7945 got at entry m+n bears little relation to the entry m. */
7946 if (addend != 0)
7947 info->callbacks->einfo
7948 /* xgettext:c-format */
7949 (_("%H: non-zero addend on %s reloc against `%s'\n"),
7950 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7951 howto->name,
7952 sym_name);
7953 }
7954 break;
7955
7956 /* Relocations that need no special processing. */
7957 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
7958 /* It makes no sense to point a local relocation
7959 at a symbol not in this object. */
7960 if (unresolved_reloc)
7961 {
7962 (*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol) (info,
7963 h->root.root.string,
7964 input_bfd,
7965 input_section,
7966 rel->r_offset,
7967 TRUE);
7968 goto copy_reloc;
7969 }
7970 if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && bfd_link_pic (info))
7971 {
7972 /* @local on an ifunc does not really make sense since
7973 the ifunc resolver can take you anywhere. More
7974 seriously, calls to ifuncs must go through a plt call
7975 stub, and for pic the plt call stubs uses r30 to
7976 access the PLT. The problem is that a call that is
7977 local won't have the +32k reloc addend trick marking
7978 -fPIC code, so the linker won't know whether r30 is
7979 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or pointing into a .got2 section. */
7980 /* xgettext:c-format */
7981 info->callbacks->einfo (_("%X%H: @local call to ifunc %s\n"),
7982 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7983 h->root.root.string);
7984 }
7985 break;
7986
7987 case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
7988 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
7989 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
7990 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
7991 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
7992 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7993 break;
7994
7995 /* Relocations that may need to be propagated if this is a shared
7996 object. */
7997 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
7998 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
7999 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
8000 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8001 if (h != NULL
8002 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
8003 && h->dynindx == -1)
8004 {
8005 /* Make this relocation against an undefined weak symbol
8006 resolve to zero. This is really just a tweak, since
8007 code using weak externs ought to check that they are
8008 defined before using them. */
8009 bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset;
8010 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8011 insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (insn, 2);
8012 if (insn != 0)
8013 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
8014 break;
8015 }
8016 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8017 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
8018 /* The TPREL16 relocs shouldn't really be used in shared
8019 libs or with non-local symbols as that will result in
8020 DT_TEXTREL being set, but support them anyway. */
8021 goto dodyn;
8022
8023 case R_PPC_TPREL32:
8024 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8025 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
8026 goto dodyn;
8027
8028 case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
8029 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8030 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
8031 goto dodyn;
8032
8033 case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
8034 relocation = 1;
8035 addend = 0;
8036 goto dodyn;
8037
8038 case R_PPC_REL16:
8039 case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
8040 case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
8041 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
8042 case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
8043 break;
8044
8045 case R_PPC_REL32:
8046 if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
8047 break;
8048 /* fall through */
8049
8050 case R_PPC_ADDR32:
8051 case R_PPC_ADDR16:
8052 case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
8053 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
8054 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
8055 case R_PPC_UADDR32:
8056 case R_PPC_UADDR16:
8057 goto dodyn;
8058
8059 case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
8060 case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
8061 case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
8062 case R_PPC_REL24:
8063 case R_PPC_REL14:
8064 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
8065 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
8066 /* If these relocations are not to a named symbol, they can be
8067 handled right here, no need to bother the dynamic linker. */
8068 if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
8069 || h == htab->elf.hgot)
8070 break;
8071 /* fall through */
8072
8073 case R_PPC_ADDR24:
8074 case R_PPC_ADDR14:
8075 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
8076 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
8077 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
8078 break;
8079 /* fall through */
8080
8081 dodyn:
8082 if ((input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
8083 || is_vxworks_tls)
8084 break;
8085
8086 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
8087 ? ((h == NULL
8088 || ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs != NULL)
8089 && ((h != NULL && pc_dynrelocs (h))
8090 || must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)))
8091 : (h != NULL
8092 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs != NULL))
8093 {
8094 int skip;
8095 bfd_byte *loc;
8096 asection *sreloc;
8097 long indx = 0;
8098
8099 #ifdef DEBUG
8100 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_relocate_section needs to "
8101 "create relocation for %s\n",
8102 (h && h->root.root.string
8103 ? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
8104 #endif
8105
8106 /* When generating a shared object, these relocations
8107 are copied into the output file to be resolved at run
8108 time. */
8109 skip = 0;
8110 outrel.r_offset = _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info,
8111 input_section,
8112 rel->r_offset);
8113 if (outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -1
8114 || outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -2)
8115 skip = (int) outrel.r_offset;
8116 outrel.r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
8117 + input_section->output_offset);
8118
8119 /* Optimize unaligned reloc use. */
8120 if ((r_type == R_PPC_ADDR32 && (outrel.r_offset & 3) != 0)
8121 || (r_type == R_PPC_UADDR32 && (outrel.r_offset & 3) == 0))
8122 r_type ^= R_PPC_ADDR32 ^ R_PPC_UADDR32;
8123 if ((r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16 && (outrel.r_offset & 1) != 0)
8124 || (r_type == R_PPC_UADDR16 && (outrel.r_offset & 1) == 0))
8125 r_type ^= R_PPC_ADDR16 ^ R_PPC_UADDR16;
8126
8127 if (skip)
8128 memset (&outrel, 0, sizeof outrel);
8129 else if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
8130 {
8131 indx = h->dynindx;
8132 BFD_ASSERT (indx != -1);
8133 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8134 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
8135 outrel.r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8136 }
8137 else
8138 {
8139 outrel.r_addend = relocation + rel->r_addend;
8140
8141 if (r_type != R_PPC_ADDR32)
8142 {
8143 if (ifunc != NULL)
8144 {
8145 /* If we get here when building a static
8146 executable, then the libc startup function
8147 responsible for applying indirect function
8148 relocations is going to complain about
8149 the reloc type.
8150 If we get here when building a dynamic
8151 executable, it will be because we have
8152 a text relocation. The dynamic loader
8153 will set the text segment writable and
8154 non-executable to apply text relocations.
8155 So we'll segfault when trying to run the
8156 indirection function to resolve the reloc. */
8157 info->callbacks->einfo
8158 /* xgettext:c-format */
8159 (_("%H: relocation %s for indirect "
8160 "function %s unsupported\n"),
8161 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8162 howto->name,
8163 sym_name);
8164 ret = FALSE;
8165 }
8166 else if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF || bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
8167 ;
8168 else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
8169 {
8170 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8171 ret = FALSE;
8172 }
8173 else
8174 {
8175 asection *osec;
8176
8177 /* We are turning this relocation into one
8178 against a section symbol. It would be
8179 proper to subtract the symbol's value,
8180 osec->vma, from the emitted reloc addend,
8181 but ld.so expects buggy relocs.
8182 FIXME: Why not always use a zero index? */
8183 osec = sec->output_section;
8184 if ((osec->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
8185 {
8186 osec = htab->elf.tls_sec;
8187 indx = 0;
8188 }
8189 else
8190 {
8191 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
8192 if (indx == 0)
8193 {
8194 osec = htab->elf.text_index_section;
8195 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
8196 }
8197 BFD_ASSERT (indx != 0);
8198 }
8199
8200 /* ld.so doesn't expect buggy TLS relocs.
8201 Don't leave the symbol value in the
8202 addend for them. */
8203 if (IS_PPC_TLS_RELOC (r_type))
8204 outrel.r_addend -= osec->vma;
8205 }
8206
8207 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
8208 }
8209 else if (ifunc != NULL)
8210 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
8211 else
8212 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
8213 }
8214
8215 sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
8216 if (ifunc)
8217 {
8218 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
8219 if (indx == 0)
8220 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
8221 else if (is_static_defined (h))
8222 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
8223 }
8224 if (sreloc == NULL)
8225 return FALSE;
8226
8227 loc = sreloc->contents;
8228 loc += sreloc->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8229 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
8230
8231 if (skip == -1)
8232 goto copy_reloc;
8233
8234 /* This reloc will be computed at runtime. Clear the memory
8235 so that it contains a predictable value for prelink. */
8236 if (!skip)
8237 {
8238 relocation = howto->pc_relative ? outrel.r_offset : 0;
8239 addend = 0;
8240 break;
8241 }
8242 }
8243 break;
8244
8245 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
8246 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
8247 if (h != NULL)
8248 {
8249 struct plt_entry *ent;
8250 bfd_vma got2_addend = 0;
8251
8252 if (r_type == R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
8253 {
8254 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8255 got2_addend = addend;
8256 addend = 0;
8257 }
8258 ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2, got2_addend);
8259 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
8260 relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
8261 + htab->glink->output_offset
8262 + ent->glink_offset);
8263 else
8264 relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
8265 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
8266 + ent->plt.offset);
8267 }
8268 /* Fall through. */
8269
8270 case R_PPC_RELAX:
8271 {
8272 const int *stub;
8273 size_t size;
8274 size_t insn_offset = rel->r_offset;
8275 unsigned int insn;
8276
8277 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8278 {
8279 relocation -= (input_section->output_section->vma
8280 + input_section->output_offset
8281 + rel->r_offset - 4);
8282 stub = shared_stub_entry;
8283 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[0], contents + insn_offset - 12);
8284 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[1], contents + insn_offset - 8);
8285 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[2], contents + insn_offset - 4);
8286 stub += 3;
8287 size = ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry) - 3;
8288 }
8289 else
8290 {
8291 stub = stub_entry;
8292 size = ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
8293 }
8294
8295 relocation += addend;
8296 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
8297 relocation = 0;
8298
8299 /* First insn is HA, second is LO. */
8300 insn = *stub++;
8301 insn |= ((relocation + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
8302 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8303 insn_offset += 4;
8304
8305 insn = *stub++;
8306 insn |= relocation & 0xffff;
8307 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8308 insn_offset += 4;
8309 size -= 2;
8310
8311 while (size != 0)
8312 {
8313 insn = *stub++;
8314 --size;
8315 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8316 insn_offset += 4;
8317 }
8318
8319 /* Rewrite the reloc and convert one of the trailing nop
8320 relocs to describe this relocation. */
8321 BFD_ASSERT (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_NONE);
8322 /* The relocs are at the bottom 2 bytes */
8323 wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset + d_offset;
8324 wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
8325 wrel->r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8326 memmove (wrel + 1, wrel, (relend - wrel - 1) * sizeof (*wrel));
8327 wrel++, rel++;
8328 wrel->r_offset += 4;
8329 wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
8330 }
8331 continue;
8332
8333 /* Indirect .sdata relocation. */
8334 case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
8335 BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[0].section != NULL);
8336 if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[0].sym))
8337 {
8338 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8339 break;
8340 }
8341 relocation
8342 = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[0],
8343 h, relocation, rel);
8344 addend = 0;
8345 break;
8346
8347 /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation. */
8348 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
8349 BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[1].section != NULL);
8350 if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[1].sym))
8351 {
8352 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8353 break;
8354 }
8355 relocation
8356 = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[1],
8357 h, relocation, rel);
8358 addend = 0;
8359 break;
8360
8361 /* Handle the TOC16 reloc. We want to use the offset within the .got
8362 section, not the actual VMA. This is appropriate when generating
8363 an embedded ELF object, for which the .got section acts like the
8364 AIX .toc section. */
8365 case R_PPC_TOC16: /* phony GOT16 relocations */
8366 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8367 {
8368 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8369 break;
8370 }
8371 BFD_ASSERT (strcmp (bfd_section_name (sec), ".got") == 0
8372 || strcmp (bfd_section_name (sec), ".cgot") == 0);
8373
8374 addend -= sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset + 0x8000;
8375 break;
8376
8377 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
8378 if (h != NULL && ifunc == NULL)
8379 {
8380 struct plt_entry *ent;
8381
8382 ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2,
8383 bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
8384 if (ent == NULL
8385 || htab->elf.splt == NULL)
8386 {
8387 /* We didn't make a PLT entry for this symbol. This
8388 happens when statically linking PIC code, or when
8389 using -Bsymbolic. */
8390 }
8391 else
8392 {
8393 /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the
8394 procedure linkage table. */
8395 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8396 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
8397 relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
8398 + htab->glink->output_offset
8399 + ent->glink_offset);
8400 else
8401 relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
8402 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
8403 + ent->plt.offset);
8404 }
8405 }
8406
8407 /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special. If non-zero, the
8408 addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2.
8409 Don't apply it to the relocation field. */
8410 addend = 0;
8411 break;
8412
8413 case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
8414 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
8415 case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
8416 case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
8417 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8418 plt_list = NULL;
8419 if (h != NULL)
8420 plt_list = &h->plt.plist;
8421 else if (ifunc != NULL)
8422 plt_list = ifunc;
8423 else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
8424 {
8425 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
8426 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
8427 + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
8428 plt_list = local_plt + r_symndx;
8429 }
8430 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8431 if (plt_list != NULL)
8432 {
8433 struct plt_entry *ent;
8434
8435 ent = find_plt_ent (plt_list, got2,
8436 bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
8437 if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
8438 {
8439 asection *plt;
8440
8441 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8442 plt = htab->elf.splt;
8443 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
8444 || h == NULL
8445 || h->dynindx == -1)
8446 {
8447 if (ifunc != NULL)
8448 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
8449 else
8450 plt = htab->pltlocal;
8451 }
8452 relocation = (plt->output_section->vma
8453 + plt->output_offset
8454 + ent->plt.offset);
8455 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8456 {
8457 bfd_vma got = 0;
8458
8459 if (ent->addend >= 32768)
8460 got = (ent->addend
8461 + ent->sec->output_section->vma
8462 + ent->sec->output_offset);
8463 else
8464 got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
8465 relocation -= got;
8466 }
8467 }
8468 }
8469 addend = 0;
8470 break;
8471
8472 /* Relocate against _SDA_BASE_. */
8473 case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
8474 {
8475 const char *name;
8476 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8477
8478 if (sec == NULL
8479 || sec->output_section == NULL
8480 || !is_static_defined (sda))
8481 {
8482 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8483 break;
8484 }
8485 addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8486
8487 name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8488 if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8489 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0))
8490 {
8491 _bfd_error_handler
8492 /* xgettext:c-format */
8493 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8494 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8495 input_bfd,
8496 sym_name,
8497 howto->name,
8498 name);
8499 }
8500 }
8501 break;
8502
8503 /* Relocate against _SDA2_BASE_. */
8504 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
8505 {
8506 const char *name;
8507 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8508
8509 if (sec == NULL
8510 || sec->output_section == NULL
8511 || !is_static_defined (sda))
8512 {
8513 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8514 break;
8515 }
8516 addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8517
8518 name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8519 if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8520 || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0))
8521 {
8522 _bfd_error_handler
8523 /* xgettext:c-format */
8524 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8525 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8526 input_bfd,
8527 sym_name,
8528 howto->name,
8529 name);
8530 }
8531 }
8532 break;
8533
8534 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
8535 relocation = relocation + addend;
8536 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8537 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8538 split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8539 goto copy_reloc;
8540
8541 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
8542 relocation = relocation + addend;
8543 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8544 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8545 split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8546 goto copy_reloc;
8547
8548 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
8549 relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
8550 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8551 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8552 split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8553 goto copy_reloc;
8554
8555 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
8556 relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
8557 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8558 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8559 split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8560 goto copy_reloc;
8561
8562 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
8563 relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
8564 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8565 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8566 split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8567 goto copy_reloc;
8568
8569 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
8570 relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
8571 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8572 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8573 split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8574 goto copy_reloc;
8575
8576 /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_, _SDA2_BASE_, or 0. */
8577 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
8578 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
8579 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
8580 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
8581 {
8582 const char *name;
8583 int reg;
8584 unsigned int insn;
8585 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
8586
8587 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8588 {
8589 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8590 break;
8591 }
8592
8593 name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8594 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8595 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
8596 {
8597 reg = 13;
8598 sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8599 }
8600 else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8601 || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
8602 {
8603 reg = 2;
8604 sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8605 }
8606 else if (strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sdata0") == 0
8607 || strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0") == 0)
8608 {
8609 reg = 0;
8610 }
8611 else
8612 {
8613 _bfd_error_handler
8614 /* xgettext:c-format */
8615 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8616 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8617 input_bfd,
8618 sym_name,
8619 howto->name,
8620 name);
8621
8622 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8623 ret = FALSE;
8624 goto copy_reloc;
8625 }
8626
8627 if (sda != NULL)
8628 {
8629 if (!is_static_defined (sda))
8630 {
8631 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8632 break;
8633 }
8634 addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8635 }
8636
8637 if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA)
8638 break;
8639
8640 /* The PowerPC Embedded Application Binary Interface
8641 version 1.0 insanely chose to specify R_PPC_EMB_SDA21
8642 operating on a 24-bit field at r_offset. GNU as and
8643 GNU ld have always assumed R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 operates on
8644 a 32-bit bit insn at r_offset. Cope with object file
8645 producers that possibly comply with the EABI in
8646 generating an odd r_offset for big-endian objects. */
8647 if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_SDA21)
8648 rel->r_offset &= ~1;
8649
8650 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
8651 if (reg == 0
8652 && (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8653 || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO))
8654 {
8655 relocation = relocation + addend;
8656 addend = 0;
8657
8658 /* Force e_li insn, keeping RT from original insn. */
8659 insn &= 0x1f << 21;
8660 insn |= 28u << 26;
8661
8662 /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31. */
8663 /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20. */
8664 insn |= (relocation & 0xf0000) >> 5;
8665 /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15. */
8666 insn |= (relocation & 0xf800) << 5;
8667 /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31. */
8668 insn |= relocation & 0x7ff;
8669
8670 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8671
8672 if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8673 && ((relocation + 0x80000) & 0xffffffff) > 0x100000)
8674 goto overflow;
8675 goto copy_reloc;
8676 }
8677 /* Fill in register field. */
8678 insn = (insn & ~RA_REGISTER_MASK) | (reg << RA_REGISTER_SHIFT);
8679 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8680 }
8681 break;
8682
8683 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
8684 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
8685 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
8686 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
8687 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
8688 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
8689 {
8690 bfd_vma value;
8691 const char *name;
8692 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
8693
8694 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8695 {
8696 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8697 break;
8698 }
8699
8700 name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8701 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8702 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
8703 sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8704 else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8705 || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
8706 sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8707 else
8708 {
8709 _bfd_error_handler
8710 /* xgettext:c-format */
8711 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8712 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8713 input_bfd,
8714 sym_name,
8715 howto->name,
8716 name);
8717
8718 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8719 ret = FALSE;
8720 goto copy_reloc;
8721 }
8722
8723 if (sda == NULL || !is_static_defined (sda))
8724 {
8725 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8726 break;
8727 }
8728 value = relocation + addend - SYM_VAL (sda);
8729
8730 if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A)
8731 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8732 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8733 split16a_type,
8734 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8735 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D)
8736 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8737 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8738 split16d_type,
8739 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8740 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A)
8741 {
8742 value = value >> 16;
8743 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8744 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8745 split16a_type,
8746 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8747 }
8748 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D)
8749 {
8750 value = value >> 16;
8751 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8752 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8753 split16d_type,
8754 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8755 }
8756 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A)
8757 {
8758 value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
8759 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8760 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8761 split16a_type,
8762 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8763 }
8764 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D)
8765 {
8766 value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
8767 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8768 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8769 split16d_type,
8770 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8771 }
8772 }
8773 goto copy_reloc;
8774
8775 case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
8776 ppc_elf_vle_split20 (output_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset, relocation);
8777 continue;
8778
8779 /* Relocate against the beginning of the section. */
8780 case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
8781 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
8782 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
8783 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
8784 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8785 {
8786 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8787 break;
8788 }
8789 addend -= sec->output_section->vma;
8790 break;
8791
8792 /* Negative relocations. */
8793 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
8794 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
8795 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
8796 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
8797 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
8798 addend -= 2 * relocation;
8799 break;
8800
8801 case R_PPC_COPY:
8802 case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
8803 case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
8804 case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
8805 case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
8806 case R_PPC_PLT32:
8807 case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
8808 case R_PPC_ADDR30:
8809 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
8810 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
8811 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
8812 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
8813 case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
8814 /* xgettext:c-format */
8815 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
8816 input_bfd, howto->name);
8817
8818 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8819 ret = FALSE;
8820 goto copy_reloc;
8821 }
8822
8823 switch (r_type)
8824 {
8825 default:
8826 break;
8827
8828 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
8829 if (unresolved_reloc)
8830 {
8831 bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset;
8832 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8833 insn &= 1;
8834 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | insn, p);
8835 unresolved_reloc = save_unresolved_reloc;
8836 r_type = R_PPC_REL24;
8837 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
8838 }
8839 else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
8840 info->callbacks->einfo
8841 (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
8842 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8843 howto->name);
8844 break;
8845
8846 case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
8847 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8848 case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
8849 if (unresolved_reloc)
8850 {
8851 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
8852 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
8853 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8854 r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
8855 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
8856 }
8857 else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
8858 info->callbacks->einfo
8859 (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
8860 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8861 howto->name);
8862 break;
8863 }
8864
8865 /* Do any further special processing. */
8866 switch (r_type)
8867 {
8868 default:
8869 break;
8870
8871 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
8872 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
8873 case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
8874 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
8875 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8876 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
8877 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
8878 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
8879 /* It's just possible that this symbol is a weak symbol
8880 that's not actually defined anywhere. In that case,
8881 'sec' would be NULL, and we should leave the symbol
8882 alone (it will be set to zero elsewhere in the link). */
8883 if (sec == NULL)
8884 break;
8885 /* Fall through. */
8886
8887 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8888 case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
8889 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
8890 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
8891 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
8892 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
8893 /* Add 0x10000 if sign bit in 0:15 is set.
8894 Bits 0:15 are not used. */
8895 addend += 0x8000;
8896 break;
8897
8898 case R_PPC_ADDR16:
8899 case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
8900 case R_PPC_GOT16:
8901 case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
8902 case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
8903 case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
8904 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
8905 case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
8906 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
8907 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
8908 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
8909 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
8910 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
8911 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
8912 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
8913 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
8914 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
8915 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
8916 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
8917 {
8918 /* The 32-bit ABI lacks proper relocations to deal with
8919 certain 64-bit instructions. Prevent damage to bits
8920 that make up part of the insn opcode. */
8921 unsigned int insn, mask, lobit;
8922
8923 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
8924 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
8925 mask = 0;
8926 if (is_insn_ds_form (insn))
8927 mask = 3;
8928 else if (is_insn_dq_form (insn))
8929 mask = 15;
8930 else
8931 break;
8932 relocation += addend;
8933 addend = insn & mask;
8934 lobit = mask & relocation;
8935 if (lobit != 0)
8936 {
8937 relocation ^= lobit;
8938 info->callbacks->einfo
8939 /* xgettext:c-format */
8940 (_("%H: error: %s against `%s' not a multiple of %u\n"),
8941 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8942 howto->name, sym_name, mask + 1);
8943 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8944 ret = FALSE;
8945 }
8946 }
8947 break;
8948 }
8949
8950 #ifdef DEBUG
8951 fprintf (stderr, "\ttype = %s (%d), name = %s, symbol index = %ld, "
8952 "offset = %ld, addend = %ld\n",
8953 howto->name,
8954 (int) r_type,
8955 sym_name,
8956 r_symndx,
8957 (long) rel->r_offset,
8958 (long) addend);
8959 #endif
8960
8961 if (unresolved_reloc
8962 && !((input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0
8963 && h->def_dynamic)
8964 && _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section,
8965 rel->r_offset) != (bfd_vma) -1)
8966 {
8967 info->callbacks->einfo
8968 /* xgettext:c-format */
8969 (_("%H: unresolvable %s relocation against symbol `%s'\n"),
8970 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8971 howto->name,
8972 sym_name);
8973 ret = FALSE;
8974 }
8975
8976 /* 16-bit fields in insns mostly have signed values, but a
8977 few insns have 16-bit unsigned values. Really, we should
8978 have different reloc types. */
8979 if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain_overflow_dont
8980 && howto->dst_mask == 0xffff
8981 && (input_section->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
8982 {
8983 enum complain_overflow complain = complain_overflow_signed;
8984
8985 if ((elf_section_flags (input_section) & SHF_PPC_VLE) == 0)
8986 {
8987 unsigned int insn;
8988
8989 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
8990 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 10u << 26 /* cmpli */)
8991 complain = complain_overflow_bitfield;
8992 else if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi */
8993 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori */
8994 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori */)
8995 complain = complain_overflow_unsigned;
8996 }
8997 if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain)
8998 {
8999 alt_howto = *howto;
9000 alt_howto.complain_on_overflow = complain;
9001 howto = &alt_howto;
9002 }
9003 }
9004
9005 if (r_type == R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
9006 {
9007 /* Split field reloc isn't handled by _bfd_final_link_relocate. */
9008 if (rel->r_offset + 4 > input_section->size)
9009 r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
9010 else
9011 {
9012 unsigned int insn;
9013
9014 relocation += addend;
9015 relocation -= (rel->r_offset
9016 + input_section->output_offset
9017 + input_section->output_section->vma);
9018 relocation >>= 16;
9019 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
9020 insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
9021 insn |= (relocation & 0xffc1) | ((relocation & 0x3e) << 15);
9022 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
9023 r = bfd_reloc_ok;
9024 }
9025 }
9026 else
9027 r = _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section, contents,
9028 rel->r_offset, relocation, addend);
9029
9030 if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
9031 {
9032 if (r == bfd_reloc_overflow)
9033 {
9034 overflow:
9035 /* On code like "if (foo) foo();" don't report overflow
9036 on a branch to zero when foo is undefined. */
9037 if (!warned
9038 && !(h != NULL
9039 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
9040 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
9041 && is_branch_reloc (r_type)))
9042 info->callbacks->reloc_overflow
9043 (info, (h ? &h->root : NULL), sym_name, howto->name,
9044 rel->r_addend, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
9045 }
9046 else
9047 {
9048 info->callbacks->einfo
9049 /* xgettext:c-format */
9050 (_("%H: %s reloc against `%s': error %d\n"),
9051 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
9052 howto->name, sym_name, (int) r);
9053 ret = FALSE;
9054 }
9055 }
9056 copy_reloc:
9057 if (wrel != rel)
9058 *wrel = *rel;
9059 }
9060
9061 if (wrel != rel)
9062 {
9063 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
9064 size_t deleted = rel - wrel;
9065
9066 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section->output_section);
9067 rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
9068 if (rel_hdr->sh_size == 0)
9069 {
9070 /* It is too late to remove an empty reloc section. Leave
9071 one NONE reloc.
9072 ??? What is wrong with an empty section??? */
9073 rel_hdr->sh_size = rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
9074 deleted -= 1;
9075 wrel++;
9076 }
9077 relend = wrel;
9078 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section);
9079 rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
9080 input_section->reloc_count -= deleted;
9081 }
9082
9083 #ifdef DEBUG
9084 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9085 #endif
9086
9087 if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
9088 && input_section->size != input_section->rawsize
9089 && (strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
9090 || strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0))
9091 {
9092 /* Branch around the trampolines. */
9093 unsigned int insn = B + input_section->size - input_section->rawsize;
9094 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + input_section->rawsize);
9095 }
9096
9097 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
9098 && input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
9099 && (!bfd_link_relocatable (info)
9100 || (input_section->output_section->alignment_power
9101 >= htab->params->pagesize_p2)))
9102 {
9103 bfd_vma start_addr, end_addr, addr;
9104 bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
9105
9106 if (relax_info->workaround_size != 0)
9107 {
9108 bfd_byte *p;
9109 unsigned int n;
9110 bfd_byte fill[4];
9111
9112 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, BA, fill);
9113 p = contents + input_section->size - relax_info->workaround_size;
9114 n = relax_info->workaround_size >> 2;
9115 while (n--)
9116 {
9117 memcpy (p, fill, 4);
9118 p += 4;
9119 }
9120 }
9121
9122 /* The idea is: Replace the last instruction on a page with a
9123 branch to a patch area. Put the insn there followed by a
9124 branch back to the next page. Complicated a little by
9125 needing to handle moved conditional branches, and by not
9126 wanting to touch data-in-text. */
9127
9128 start_addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
9129 + input_section->output_offset);
9130 end_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
9131 - relax_info->workaround_size);
9132 for (addr = ((start_addr & -pagesize) + pagesize - 4);
9133 addr < end_addr;
9134 addr += pagesize)
9135 {
9136 bfd_vma offset = addr - start_addr;
9137 Elf_Internal_Rela *lo, *hi;
9138 bfd_boolean is_data;
9139 bfd_vma patch_off, patch_addr;
9140 unsigned int insn;
9141
9142 /* Do we have a data reloc at this offset? If so, leave
9143 the word alone. */
9144 is_data = FALSE;
9145 lo = relocs;
9146 hi = relend;
9147 rel = NULL;
9148 while (lo < hi)
9149 {
9150 rel = lo + (hi - lo) / 2;
9151 if (rel->r_offset < offset)
9152 lo = rel + 1;
9153 else if (rel->r_offset > offset + 3)
9154 hi = rel;
9155 else
9156 {
9157 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
9158 {
9159 case R_PPC_ADDR32:
9160 case R_PPC_UADDR32:
9161 case R_PPC_REL32:
9162 case R_PPC_ADDR30:
9163 is_data = TRUE;
9164 break;
9165 default:
9166 break;
9167 }
9168 break;
9169 }
9170 }
9171 if (is_data)
9172 continue;
9173
9174 /* Some instructions can be left alone too. Unconditional
9175 branches, except for bcctr with BO=0x14 (bctr, bctrl),
9176 avoid the icache failure.
9177
9178 The problem occurs due to prefetch across a page boundary
9179 where stale instructions can be fetched from the next
9180 page, and the mechanism for flushing these bad
9181 instructions fails under certain circumstances. The
9182 unconditional branches:
9183 1) Branch: b, bl, ba, bla,
9184 2) Branch Conditional: bc, bca, bcl, bcla,
9185 3) Branch Conditional to Link Register: bclr, bclrl,
9186 where (2) and (3) have BO=0x14 making them unconditional,
9187 prevent the bad prefetch because the prefetch itself is
9188 affected by these instructions. This happens even if the
9189 instruction is not executed.
9190
9191 A bctr example:
9192 .
9193 . lis 9,new_page@ha
9194 . addi 9,9,new_page@l
9195 . mtctr 9
9196 . bctr
9197 . nop
9198 . nop
9199 . new_page:
9200 .
9201 The bctr is not predicted taken due to ctr not being
9202 ready, so prefetch continues on past the bctr into the
9203 new page which might have stale instructions. If they
9204 fail to be flushed, then they will be executed after the
9205 bctr executes. Either of the following modifications
9206 prevent the bad prefetch from happening in the first
9207 place:
9208 .
9209 . lis 9,new_page@ha lis 9,new_page@ha
9210 . addi 9,9,new_page@l addi 9,9,new_page@l
9211 . mtctr 9 mtctr 9
9212 . bctr bctr
9213 . nop b somewhere_else
9214 . b somewhere_else nop
9215 . new_page: new_page:
9216 . */
9217 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
9218 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (18u << 26) /* b,bl,ba,bla */
9219 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc,bcl,bca,bcla*/
9220 && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)) /* with BO=0x14 */
9221 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (19u << 26)
9222 && (insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == (16u << 1) /* bclr,bclrl */
9223 && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)))/* with BO=0x14 */
9224 continue;
9225
9226 patch_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
9227 - relax_info->workaround_size);
9228 patch_addr = (patch_addr + 15) & -16;
9229 patch_off = patch_addr - start_addr;
9230 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B + patch_off - offset, contents + offset);
9231
9232 if (rel != NULL
9233 && rel->r_offset >= offset
9234 && rel->r_offset < offset + 4)
9235 {
9236 asection *sreloc;
9237
9238 /* If the insn we are patching had a reloc, adjust the
9239 reloc r_offset so that the reloc applies to the moved
9240 location. This matters for -r and --emit-relocs. */
9241 if (rel + 1 != relend)
9242 {
9243 Elf_Internal_Rela tmp = *rel;
9244
9245 /* Keep the relocs sorted by r_offset. */
9246 memmove (rel, rel + 1, (relend - (rel + 1)) * sizeof (*rel));
9247 relend[-1] = tmp;
9248 }
9249 relend[-1].r_offset += patch_off - offset;
9250
9251 /* Adjust REL16 addends too. */
9252 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info))
9253 {
9254 case R_PPC_REL16:
9255 case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
9256 case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
9257 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
9258 relend[-1].r_addend += patch_off - offset;
9259 break;
9260 default:
9261 break;
9262 }
9263
9264 /* If we are building a PIE or shared library with
9265 non-PIC objects, perhaps we had a dynamic reloc too?
9266 If so, the dynamic reloc must move with the insn. */
9267 sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
9268 if (sreloc != NULL)
9269 {
9270 Elf32_External_Rela *slo, *shi, *srelend;
9271 bfd_vma soffset;
9272
9273 slo = (Elf32_External_Rela *) sreloc->contents;
9274 shi = srelend = slo + sreloc->reloc_count;
9275 soffset = (offset + input_section->output_section->vma
9276 + input_section->output_offset);
9277 while (slo < shi)
9278 {
9279 Elf32_External_Rela *srel = slo + (shi - slo) / 2;
9280 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, (bfd_byte *) srel,
9281 &outrel);
9282 if (outrel.r_offset < soffset)
9283 slo = srel + 1;
9284 else if (outrel.r_offset > soffset + 3)
9285 shi = srel;
9286 else
9287 {
9288 if (srel + 1 != srelend)
9289 {
9290 memmove (srel, srel + 1,
9291 (srelend - (srel + 1)) * sizeof (*srel));
9292 srel = srelend - 1;
9293 }
9294 outrel.r_offset += patch_off - offset;
9295 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel,
9296 (bfd_byte *) srel);
9297 break;
9298 }
9299 }
9300 }
9301 }
9302 else
9303 rel = NULL;
9304
9305 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc */
9306 && (insn & 2) == 0 /* relative */)
9307 {
9308 bfd_vma delta = ((insn & 0xfffc) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
9309
9310 delta += offset - patch_off;
9311 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
9312 delta = 0;
9313 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
9314 {
9315 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
9316
9317 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info);
9318 if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN)
9319 insn |= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9320 else if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9321 insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9322 else
9323 BFD_ASSERT (r_type == R_PPC_REL14);
9324
9325 if ((r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
9326 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9327 && delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000
9328 && (bfd_signed_vma) delta < 0)
9329 insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9330 }
9331 if (delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
9332 {
9333 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9334 (insn & ~0xfffc) | (delta & 0xfffc),
9335 contents + patch_off);
9336 patch_off += 4;
9337 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9338 B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9339 contents + patch_off);
9340 patch_off += 4;
9341 }
9342 else
9343 {
9344 if (rel != NULL)
9345 {
9346 unsigned int r_sym = ELF32_R_SYM (relend[-1].r_info);
9347
9348 relend[-1].r_offset += 8;
9349 relend[-1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_sym, R_PPC_REL24);
9350 }
9351 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9352 (insn & ~0xfffc) | 8,
9353 contents + patch_off);
9354 patch_off += 4;
9355 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9356 B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9357 contents + patch_off);
9358 patch_off += 4;
9359 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9360 B | ((delta - 8) & 0x3fffffc),
9361 contents + patch_off);
9362 patch_off += 4;
9363 }
9364 }
9365 else
9366 {
9367 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + patch_off);
9368 patch_off += 4;
9369 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9370 B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9371 contents + patch_off);
9372 patch_off += 4;
9373 }
9374 BFD_ASSERT (patch_off <= input_section->size);
9375 relax_info->workaround_size = input_section->size - patch_off;
9376 }
9377 }
9378
9379 return ret;
9380 }
9381 \f
9382 /* Write out the PLT relocs and entries for H. */
9383
9384 static bfd_boolean
9385 write_global_sym_plt (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
9386 {
9387 struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
9388 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9389 struct plt_entry *ent;
9390 bfd_boolean doneone;
9391
9392 doneone = FALSE;
9393 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9394 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9395 {
9396 if (!doneone)
9397 {
9398 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9399 bfd_byte *loc;
9400 bfd_vma reloc_index;
9401 asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
9402 asection *relplt = htab->elf.srelplt;
9403
9404 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
9405 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9406 || h->dynindx == -1)
9407 reloc_index = ent->plt.offset / 4;
9408 else
9409 {
9410 reloc_index = ((ent->plt.offset - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
9411 / htab->plt_slot_size);
9412 if (reloc_index > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES
9413 && htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
9414 reloc_index -= (reloc_index - PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES) / 2;
9415 }
9416
9417 /* This symbol has an entry in the procedure linkage table.
9418 Set it up. */
9419 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS
9420 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9421 && h->dynindx != -1)
9422 {
9423 bfd_vma got_offset;
9424 const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
9425
9426 /* The first three entries in .got.plt are reserved. */
9427 got_offset = (reloc_index + 3) * 4;
9428
9429 /* Use the right PLT. */
9430 plt_entry = bfd_link_pic (info) ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
9431 : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry;
9432
9433 /* Fill in the .plt on VxWorks. */
9434 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9435 {
9436 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9437 plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_offset),
9438 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
9439 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9440 plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_offset),
9441 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
9442 }
9443 else
9444 {
9445 bfd_vma got_loc = got_offset + SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9446
9447 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9448 plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_loc),
9449 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
9450 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9451 plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_loc),
9452 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
9453 }
9454
9455 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[2],
9456 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 8);
9457 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[3],
9458 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 12);
9459
9460 /* This instruction is an immediate load. The value loaded is
9461 the byte offset of the R_PPC_JMP_SLOT relocation from the
9462 start of the .rela.plt section. The value is stored in the
9463 low-order 16 bits of the load instruction. */
9464 /* NOTE: It appears that this is now an index rather than a
9465 prescaled offset. */
9466 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9467 plt_entry[4] | reloc_index,
9468 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 16);
9469 /* This instruction is a PC-relative branch whose target is
9470 the start of the PLT section. The address of this branch
9471 instruction is 20 bytes beyond the start of this PLT entry.
9472 The address is encoded in bits 6-29, inclusive. The value
9473 stored is right-shifted by two bits, permitting a 26-bit
9474 offset. */
9475 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9476 (plt_entry[5]
9477 | (-(ent->plt.offset + 20) & 0x03fffffc)),
9478 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 20);
9479 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[6],
9480 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 24);
9481 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[7],
9482 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 28);
9483
9484 /* Fill in the GOT entry corresponding to this PLT slot with
9485 the address immediately after the "bctr" instruction
9486 in this PLT entry. */
9487 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, (plt->output_section->vma
9488 + plt->output_offset
9489 + ent->plt.offset + 16),
9490 htab->elf.sgotplt->contents + got_offset);
9491
9492 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9493 {
9494 /* Fill in a couple of entries in .rela.plt.unloaded. */
9495 loc = htab->srelplt2->contents
9496 + ((VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS + reloc_index
9497 * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS)
9498 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9499
9500 /* Provide the @ha relocation for the first instruction. */
9501 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9502 + plt->output_offset
9503 + ent->plt.offset + 2);
9504 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
9505 R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
9506 rela.r_addend = got_offset;
9507 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9508 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9509
9510 /* Provide the @l relocation for the second instruction. */
9511 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9512 + plt->output_offset
9513 + ent->plt.offset + 6);
9514 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
9515 R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
9516 rela.r_addend = got_offset;
9517 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9518 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9519
9520 /* Provide a relocation for the GOT entry corresponding to this
9521 PLT slot. Point it at the middle of the .plt entry. */
9522 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
9523 + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
9524 + got_offset);
9525 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx,
9526 R_PPC_ADDR32);
9527 rela.r_addend = ent->plt.offset + 16;
9528 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9529 }
9530
9531 /* VxWorks uses non-standard semantics for R_PPC_JMP_SLOT.
9532 In particular, the offset for the relocation is not the
9533 address of the PLT entry for this function, as specified
9534 by the ABI. Instead, the offset is set to the address of
9535 the GOT slot for this function. See EABI 4.4.4.1. */
9536 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
9537 + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
9538 + got_offset);
9539 rela.r_addend = 0;
9540 }
9541 else
9542 {
9543 rela.r_addend = 0;
9544 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9545 || h->dynindx == -1)
9546 {
9547 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9548 {
9549 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9550 relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
9551 }
9552 else
9553 {
9554 plt = htab->pltlocal;
9555 relplt = bfd_link_pic (info) ? htab->relpltlocal : NULL;
9556 }
9557 if (h->def_regular
9558 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
9559 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
9560 rela.r_addend = SYM_VAL (h);
9561 }
9562
9563 if (relplt == NULL)
9564 {
9565 loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
9566 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, rela.r_addend, loc);
9567 }
9568 else
9569 {
9570 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9571 + plt->output_offset
9572 + ent->plt.offset);
9573
9574 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
9575 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9576 || h->dynindx == -1)
9577 {
9578 /* We don't need to fill in the .plt. The ppc dynamic
9579 linker will fill it in. */
9580 }
9581 else
9582 {
9583 bfd_vma val = (htab->glink_pltresolve + ent->plt.offset
9584 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
9585 + htab->glink->output_offset);
9586 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val,
9587 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset);
9588 }
9589 }
9590 }
9591
9592 if (relplt != NULL)
9593 {
9594 /* Fill in the entry in the .rela.plt section. */
9595 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9596 || h->dynindx == -1)
9597 {
9598 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9599 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
9600 else
9601 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
9602 loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
9603 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9604 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9605 }
9606 else
9607 {
9608 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_JMP_SLOT);
9609 loc = relplt->contents + (reloc_index
9610 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9611 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && is_static_defined (h))
9612 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9613 }
9614 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9615 }
9616 doneone = TRUE;
9617 }
9618
9619 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
9620 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9621 || h->dynindx == -1)
9622 {
9623 unsigned char *p;
9624 asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
9625
9626 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9627 || h->dynindx == -1)
9628 {
9629 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9630 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9631 else
9632 break;
9633 }
9634
9635 p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
9636 write_glink_stub (h, ent, plt, p, info);
9637
9638 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9639 /* We only need one non-PIC glink stub. */
9640 break;
9641 }
9642 else
9643 break;
9644 }
9645 return TRUE;
9646 }
9647
9648 /* Finish up PLT handling. */
9649
9650 bfd_boolean
9651 ppc_finish_symbols (struct bfd_link_info *info)
9652 {
9653 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9654 bfd *ibfd;
9655
9656 if (!htab)
9657 return TRUE;
9658
9659 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, write_global_sym_plt, info);
9660
9661 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
9662 {
9663 bfd_vma *local_got, *end_local_got;
9664 struct plt_entry **local_plt, **lplt, **end_local_plt;
9665 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
9666 bfd_size_type locsymcount;
9667 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms = NULL;
9668 struct plt_entry *ent;
9669
9670 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
9671 continue;
9672
9673 local_got = elf_local_got_offsets (ibfd);
9674 if (!local_got)
9675 continue;
9676
9677 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
9678 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
9679 end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
9680 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
9681 end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
9682 for (lplt = local_plt; lplt < end_local_plt; ++lplt)
9683 for (ent = *lplt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9684 {
9685 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9686 {
9687 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
9688 asection *sym_sec;
9689 asection *plt, *relplt;
9690 bfd_byte *loc;
9691 bfd_vma val;
9692 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9693 unsigned char *p;
9694
9695 if (!get_sym_h (NULL, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
9696 lplt - local_plt, ibfd))
9697 {
9698 if (local_syms != NULL
9699 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9700 free (local_syms);
9701 return FALSE;
9702 }
9703
9704 val = sym->st_value;
9705 if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
9706 val += sym_sec->output_offset + sym_sec->output_section->vma;
9707
9708 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9709 {
9710 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9711 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9712 relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
9713 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
9714 }
9715 else
9716 {
9717 plt = htab->pltlocal;
9718 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9719 {
9720 relplt = htab->relpltlocal;
9721 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
9722 }
9723 else
9724 {
9725 loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
9726 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val, loc);
9727 continue;
9728 }
9729 }
9730
9731 rela.r_offset = (ent->plt.offset
9732 + plt->output_offset
9733 + plt->output_section->vma);
9734 rela.r_addend = val;
9735 loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
9736 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9737 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9738
9739 p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
9740 write_glink_stub (NULL, ent, htab->elf.iplt, p, info);
9741 }
9742 }
9743
9744 if (local_syms != NULL
9745 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9746 {
9747 if (!info->keep_memory)
9748 free (local_syms);
9749 else
9750 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
9751 }
9752 }
9753 return TRUE;
9754 }
9755
9756 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. We set the contents of various
9757 dynamic sections here. */
9758
9759 static bfd_boolean
9760 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
9761 struct bfd_link_info *info,
9762 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
9763 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
9764 {
9765 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9766 struct plt_entry *ent;
9767
9768 #ifdef DEBUG
9769 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol called for %s",
9770 h->root.root.string);
9771 #endif
9772
9773 if (!h->def_regular
9774 || (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && !bfd_link_pic (info)))
9775 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9776 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9777 {
9778 if (!h->def_regular)
9779 {
9780 /* Mark the symbol as undefined, rather than as
9781 defined in the .plt section. Leave the value if
9782 there were any relocations where pointer equality
9783 matters (this is a clue for the dynamic linker, to
9784 make function pointer comparisons work between an
9785 application and shared library), otherwise set it
9786 to zero. */
9787 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
9788 if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
9789 sym->st_value = 0;
9790 else if (!h->ref_regular_nonweak)
9791 {
9792 /* This breaks function pointer comparisons, but
9793 that is better than breaking tests for a NULL
9794 function pointer. */
9795 sym->st_value = 0;
9796 }
9797 }
9798 else
9799 {
9800 /* Set the value of ifunc symbols in a non-pie
9801 executable to the glink entry. This is to avoid
9802 text relocations. We can't do this for ifunc in
9803 allocate_dynrelocs, as we do for normal dynamic
9804 function symbols with plt entries, because we need
9805 to keep the original value around for the ifunc
9806 relocation. */
9807 sym->st_shndx
9808 = (_bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
9809 (info->output_bfd, htab->glink->output_section));
9810 sym->st_value = (ent->glink_offset
9811 + htab->glink->output_offset
9812 + htab->glink->output_section->vma);
9813 }
9814 break;
9815 }
9816
9817 if (h->needs_copy)
9818 {
9819 asection *s;
9820 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9821 bfd_byte *loc;
9822
9823 /* This symbols needs a copy reloc. Set it up. */
9824
9825 #ifdef DEBUG
9826 fprintf (stderr, ", copy");
9827 #endif
9828
9829 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
9830
9831 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
9832 s = htab->relsbss;
9833 else if (h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
9834 s = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
9835 else
9836 s = htab->elf.srelbss;
9837 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
9838
9839 rela.r_offset = SYM_VAL (h);
9840 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_COPY);
9841 rela.r_addend = 0;
9842 loc = s->contents + s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9843 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9844 }
9845
9846 #ifdef DEBUG
9847 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9848 #endif
9849
9850 return TRUE;
9851 }
9852 \f
9853 static enum elf_reloc_type_class
9854 ppc_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info,
9855 const asection *rel_sec,
9856 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela)
9857 {
9858 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9859
9860 if (rel_sec == htab->elf.irelplt)
9861 return reloc_class_ifunc;
9862
9863 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rela->r_info))
9864 {
9865 case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
9866 return reloc_class_relative;
9867 case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
9868 return reloc_class_plt;
9869 case R_PPC_COPY:
9870 return reloc_class_copy;
9871 default:
9872 return reloc_class_normal;
9873 }
9874 }
9875 \f
9876 /* Finish up the dynamic sections. */
9877
9878 static bfd_boolean
9879 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
9880 struct bfd_link_info *info)
9881 {
9882 asection *sdyn;
9883 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9884 bfd_vma got;
9885 bfd *dynobj;
9886 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
9887
9888 #ifdef DEBUG
9889 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections called\n");
9890 #endif
9891
9892 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9893 dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj;
9894 sdyn = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".dynamic");
9895
9896 got = 0;
9897 if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
9898 got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9899
9900 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
9901 {
9902 Elf32_External_Dyn *dyncon, *dynconend;
9903
9904 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.splt != NULL && sdyn != NULL);
9905
9906 dyncon = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) sdyn->contents;
9907 dynconend = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) (sdyn->contents + sdyn->size);
9908 for (; dyncon < dynconend; dyncon++)
9909 {
9910 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
9911 asection *s;
9912
9913 bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_in (dynobj, dyncon, &dyn);
9914
9915 switch (dyn.d_tag)
9916 {
9917 case DT_PLTGOT:
9918 if (htab->is_vxworks)
9919 s = htab->elf.sgotplt;
9920 else
9921 s = htab->elf.splt;
9922 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
9923 break;
9924
9925 case DT_PLTRELSZ:
9926 dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->elf.srelplt->size;
9927 break;
9928
9929 case DT_JMPREL:
9930 s = htab->elf.srelplt;
9931 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
9932 break;
9933
9934 case DT_PPC_GOT:
9935 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = got;
9936 break;
9937
9938 case DT_TEXTREL:
9939 if (htab->local_ifunc_resolver)
9940 info->callbacks->einfo
9941 (_("%X%P: text relocations and GNU indirect "
9942 "functions will result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
9943 else if (htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver)
9944 info->callbacks->einfo
9945 (_("%P: warning: text relocations and GNU indirect "
9946 "functions may result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
9947 continue;
9948
9949 default:
9950 if (htab->is_vxworks
9951 && elf_vxworks_finish_dynamic_entry (output_bfd, &dyn))
9952 break;
9953 continue;
9954 }
9955
9956 bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
9957 }
9958 }
9959
9960 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
9961 && htab->elf.sgot->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
9962 {
9963 if (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgot
9964 || htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgotplt)
9965 {
9966 unsigned char *p = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->contents;
9967
9968 p += htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
9969 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
9970 {
9971 /* Add a blrl instruction at _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_-4
9972 so that a function can easily find the address of
9973 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
9974 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value - 4
9975 < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
9976 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0x4e800021, p - 4);
9977 }
9978
9979 if (sdyn != NULL)
9980 {
9981 bfd_vma val = sdyn->output_section->vma + sdyn->output_offset;
9982 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value
9983 < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
9984 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, val, p);
9985 }
9986 }
9987 else
9988 {
9989 /* xgettext:c-format */
9990 _bfd_error_handler (_("%s not defined in linker created %pA"),
9991 htab->elf.hgot->root.root.string,
9992 (htab->elf.sgotplt != NULL
9993 ? htab->elf.sgotplt : htab->elf.sgot));
9994 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
9995 ret = FALSE;
9996 }
9997
9998 elf_section_data (htab->elf.sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize = 4;
9999 }
10000
10001 /* Fill in the first entry in the VxWorks procedure linkage table. */
10002 if (htab->is_vxworks
10003 && htab->elf.splt != NULL
10004 && htab->elf.splt->size != 0
10005 && htab->elf.splt->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
10006 {
10007 asection *splt = htab->elf.splt;
10008 /* Use the right PLT. */
10009 const bfd_vma *plt_entry = (bfd_link_pic (info)
10010 ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
10011 : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry);
10012
10013 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
10014 {
10015 bfd_vma got_value = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
10016
10017 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_value),
10018 splt->contents + 0);
10019 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_value),
10020 splt->contents + 4);
10021 }
10022 else
10023 {
10024 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0], splt->contents + 0);
10025 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1], splt->contents + 4);
10026 }
10027 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], splt->contents + 8);
10028 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], splt->contents + 12);
10029 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], splt->contents + 16);
10030 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], splt->contents + 20);
10031 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], splt->contents + 24);
10032 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], splt->contents + 28);
10033
10034 if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
10035 {
10036 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
10037 bfd_byte *loc;
10038
10039 loc = htab->srelplt2->contents;
10040
10041 /* Output the @ha relocation for the first instruction. */
10042 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
10043 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
10044 + 2);
10045 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
10046 rela.r_addend = 0;
10047 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
10048 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10049
10050 /* Output the @l relocation for the second instruction. */
10051 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
10052 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
10053 + 6);
10054 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
10055 rela.r_addend = 0;
10056 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
10057 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10058
10059 /* Fix up the remaining relocations. They may have the wrong
10060 symbol index for _G_O_T_ or _P_L_T_ depending on the order
10061 in which symbols were output. */
10062 while (loc < htab->srelplt2->contents + htab->srelplt2->size)
10063 {
10064 Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
10065
10066 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10067 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
10068 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10069 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10070
10071 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10072 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
10073 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10074 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10075
10076 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10077 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx, R_PPC_ADDR32);
10078 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10079 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10080 }
10081 }
10082 }
10083
10084 if (htab->glink != NULL
10085 && htab->glink->contents != NULL
10086 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
10087 {
10088 unsigned char *p;
10089 unsigned char *endp;
10090 bfd_vma res0;
10091
10092 /*
10093 * PIC glink code is the following:
10094 *
10095 * # ith PLT code stub.
10096 * addis 11,30,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@ha
10097 * lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@l(11)
10098 * mtctr 11
10099 * bctr
10100 *
10101 * # A table of branches, one for each plt entry.
10102 * # The idea is that the plt call stub loads ctr and r11 with these
10103 * # addresses, so (r11 - res_0) gives the plt index * 4.
10104 * res_0: b PLTresolve
10105 * res_1: b PLTresolve
10106 * .
10107 * # Some number of entries towards the end can be nops
10108 * res_n_m3: nop
10109 * res_n_m2: nop
10110 * res_n_m1:
10111 *
10112 * PLTresolve:
10113 * addis 11,11,(1f-res_0)@ha
10114 * mflr 0
10115 * bcl 20,31,1f
10116 * 1: addi 11,11,(1b-res_0)@l
10117 * mflr 12
10118 * mtlr 0
10119 * sub 11,11,12 # r11 = index * 4
10120 * addis 12,12,(got+4-1b)@ha
10121 * lwz 0,(got+4-1b)@l(12) # got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
10122 * lwz 12,(got+8-1b)@l(12) # got[2] contains the map address
10123 * mtctr 0
10124 * add 0,11,11
10125 * add 11,0,11 # r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
10126 * bctr
10127 *
10128 * Non-PIC glink code is a little simpler.
10129 *
10130 * # ith PLT code stub.
10131 * lis 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@ha
10132 * lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@l(11)
10133 * mtctr 11
10134 * bctr
10135 *
10136 * The branch table is the same, then comes
10137 *
10138 * PLTresolve:
10139 * lis 12,(got+4)@ha
10140 * addis 11,11,(-res_0)@ha
10141 * lwz 0,(got+4)@l(12) # got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
10142 * addi 11,11,(-res_0)@l # r11 = index * 4
10143 * mtctr 0
10144 * add 0,11,11
10145 * lwz 12,(got+8)@l(12) # got[2] contains the map address
10146 * add 11,0,11 # r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
10147 * bctr
10148 */
10149
10150 /* Build the branch table, one for each plt entry (less one),
10151 and perhaps some padding. */
10152 p = htab->glink->contents;
10153 p += htab->glink_pltresolve;
10154 endp = htab->glink->contents;
10155 endp += htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
10156 while (p < endp - (htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 0 : 8 * 4))
10157 {
10158 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B + endp - p, p);
10159 p += 4;
10160 }
10161 while (p < endp)
10162 {
10163 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
10164 p += 4;
10165 }
10166
10167 res0 = (htab->glink_pltresolve
10168 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
10169 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10170
10171 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround)
10172 {
10173 /* Ensure that a call stub at the end of a page doesn't
10174 result in prefetch over the end of the page into the
10175 glink branch table. */
10176 bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
10177 bfd_vma page_addr;
10178 bfd_vma glink_start = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
10179 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10180
10181 for (page_addr = res0 & -pagesize;
10182 page_addr > glink_start;
10183 page_addr -= pagesize)
10184 {
10185 /* We have a plt call stub that may need fixing. */
10186 bfd_byte *loc;
10187 unsigned int insn;
10188
10189 loc = htab->glink->contents + page_addr - 4 - glink_start;
10190 insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
10191 if (insn == BCTR)
10192 {
10193 /* By alignment, we know that there must be at least
10194 one other call stub before this one. */
10195 insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc - 16);
10196 if (insn == BCTR)
10197 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-16 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
10198 else
10199 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-20 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
10200 }
10201 }
10202 }
10203
10204 /* Last comes the PLTresolve stub. */
10205 endp = p + GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
10206 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
10207 {
10208 bfd_vma bcl;
10209
10210 bcl = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 3*4
10211 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
10212 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10213
10214 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (bcl - res0), p);
10215 p += 4;
10216 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_0, p);
10217 p += 4;
10218 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCL_20_31, p);
10219 p += 4;
10220 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (bcl - res0), p);
10221 p += 4;
10222 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_12, p);
10223 p += 4;
10224 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTLR_0, p);
10225 p += 4;
10226 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, SUB_11_11_12, p);
10227 p += 4;
10228 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_12_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10229 p += 4;
10230 if (PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl) == PPC_HA (got + 8 - bcl))
10231 {
10232 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10233 p += 4;
10234 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8 - bcl), p);
10235 p += 4;
10236 }
10237 else
10238 {
10239 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10240 p += 4;
10241 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
10242 p += 4;
10243 }
10244 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
10245 p += 4;
10246 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
10247 }
10248 else
10249 {
10250 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4), p);
10251 p += 4;
10252 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (-res0), p);
10253 p += 4;
10254 if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
10255 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
10256 else
10257 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
10258 p += 4;
10259 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (-res0), p);
10260 p += 4;
10261 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
10262 p += 4;
10263 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
10264 p += 4;
10265 if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
10266 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8), p);
10267 else
10268 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
10269 }
10270 p += 4;
10271 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_11_0_11, p);
10272 p += 4;
10273 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
10274 p += 4;
10275 while (p < endp)
10276 {
10277 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
10278 htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
10279 p += 4;
10280 }
10281 BFD_ASSERT (p == endp);
10282 }
10283
10284 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
10285 && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
10286 {
10287 unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
10288 bfd_vma val;
10289
10290 p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
10291 /* FDE length. */
10292 p += 4;
10293 /* CIE pointer. */
10294 p += 4;
10295 /* Offset to .glink. */
10296 val = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
10297 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10298 val -= (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->vma
10299 + htab->glink_eh_frame->output_offset);
10300 val -= p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
10301 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
10302
10303 if (htab->glink_eh_frame->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME
10304 && !_bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame (output_bfd, info,
10305 htab->glink_eh_frame,
10306 htab->glink_eh_frame->contents))
10307 return FALSE;
10308 }
10309
10310 return ret;
10311 }
10312 \f
10313 #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM powerpc_elf32_le_vec
10314 #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME "elf32-powerpcle"
10315 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_vec
10316 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc"
10317 #define ELF_ARCH bfd_arch_powerpc
10318 #define ELF_TARGET_ID PPC32_ELF_DATA
10319 #define ELF_MACHINE_CODE EM_PPC
10320 #define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE 0x10000
10321 #define ELF_COMMONPAGESIZE 0x1000
10322 #define ELF_RELROPAGESIZE ELF_MAXPAGESIZE
10323 #define elf_info_to_howto ppc_elf_info_to_howto
10324
10325 #ifdef EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
10326 #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT1 EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
10327 #endif
10328
10329 #ifdef EM_PPC_OLD
10330 #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT2 EM_PPC_OLD
10331 #endif
10332
10333 #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 1
10334 #define elf_backend_want_dynrelro 1
10335 #define elf_backend_can_gc_sections 1
10336 #define elf_backend_can_refcount 1
10337 #define elf_backend_rela_normal 1
10338 #define elf_backend_caches_rawsize 1
10339
10340 #define bfd_elf32_mkobject ppc_elf_mkobject
10341 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_merge_private_bfd_data ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data
10342 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_relax_section ppc_elf_relax_section
10343 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_type_lookup ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup
10344 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_name_lookup ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup
10345 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_set_private_flags ppc_elf_set_private_flags
10346 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create
10347 #define bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab
10348
10349 #define elf_backend_object_p ppc_elf_object_p
10350 #define elf_backend_gc_mark_hook ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook
10351 #define elf_backend_section_from_shdr ppc_elf_section_from_shdr
10352 #define elf_backend_relocate_section ppc_elf_relocate_section
10353 #define elf_backend_create_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections
10354 #define elf_backend_check_relocs ppc_elf_check_relocs
10355 #define elf_backend_relocs_compatible _bfd_elf_relocs_compatible
10356 #define elf_backend_copy_indirect_symbol ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol
10357 #define elf_backend_adjust_dynamic_symbol ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol
10358 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook
10359 #define elf_backend_size_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections
10360 #define elf_backend_hash_symbol ppc_elf_hash_symbol
10361 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_symbol ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol
10362 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections
10363 #define elf_backend_fake_sections ppc_elf_fake_sections
10364 #define elf_backend_additional_program_headers ppc_elf_additional_program_headers
10365 #define elf_backend_modify_segment_map ppc_elf_modify_segment_map
10366 #define elf_backend_grok_prstatus ppc_elf_grok_prstatus
10367 #define elf_backend_grok_psinfo ppc_elf_grok_psinfo
10368 #define elf_backend_write_core_note ppc_elf_write_core_note
10369 #define elf_backend_reloc_type_class ppc_elf_reloc_type_class
10370 #define elf_backend_begin_write_processing ppc_elf_begin_write_processing
10371 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing ppc_elf_final_write_processing
10372 #define elf_backend_write_section ppc_elf_write_section
10373 #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr
10374 #define elf_backend_plt_sym_val ppc_elf_plt_sym_val
10375 #define elf_backend_action_discarded ppc_elf_action_discarded
10376 #define elf_backend_init_index_section _bfd_elf_init_1_index_section
10377 #define elf_backend_lookup_section_flags_hook ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags
10378
10379 #include "elf32-target.h"
10380
10381 /* FreeBSD Target */
10382
10383 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
10384 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
10385
10386 #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
10387 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_fbsd_vec
10388 #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
10389 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-freebsd"
10390
10391 #undef ELF_OSABI
10392 #define ELF_OSABI ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
10393
10394 #undef elf32_bed
10395 #define elf32_bed elf32_powerpc_fbsd_bed
10396
10397 #include "elf32-target.h"
10398
10399 /* VxWorks Target */
10400
10401 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
10402 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
10403
10404 #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
10405 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_vxworks_vec
10406 #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
10407 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-vxworks"
10408
10409 #undef ELF_OSABI
10410
10411 /* VxWorks uses the elf default section flags for .plt. */
10412 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
10413 ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
10414 {
10415 if (sec->name == NULL)
10416 return NULL;
10417
10418 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".plt") == 0)
10419 return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
10420
10421 return ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
10422 }
10423
10424 /* Like ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create, but overrides
10425 appropriately for VxWorks. */
10426 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
10427 ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
10428 {
10429 struct bfd_link_hash_table *ret;
10430
10431 ret = ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (abfd);
10432 if (ret)
10433 {
10434 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab
10435 = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *)ret;
10436 htab->is_vxworks = 1;
10437 htab->plt_type = PLT_VXWORKS;
10438 htab->plt_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10439 htab->plt_slot_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10440 htab->plt_initial_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE;
10441 }
10442 return ret;
10443 }
10444
10445 /* Tweak magic VxWorks symbols as they are loaded. */
10446 static bfd_boolean
10447 ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
10448 struct bfd_link_info *info,
10449 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
10450 const char **namep,
10451 flagword *flagsp,
10452 asection **secp,
10453 bfd_vma *valp)
10454 {
10455 if (!elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp,
10456 valp))
10457 return FALSE;
10458
10459 return ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp, valp);
10460 }
10461
10462 static bfd_boolean
10463 ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
10464 {
10465 ppc_final_write_processing (abfd);
10466 return elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (abfd);
10467 }
10468
10469 /* On VxWorks, we emit relocations against _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_, so
10470 define it. */
10471 #undef elf_backend_want_plt_sym
10472 #define elf_backend_want_plt_sym 1
10473 #undef elf_backend_want_got_plt
10474 #define elf_backend_want_got_plt 1
10475 #undef elf_backend_got_symbol_offset
10476 #define elf_backend_got_symbol_offset 0
10477 #undef elf_backend_plt_not_loaded
10478 #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 0
10479 #undef elf_backend_plt_readonly
10480 #define elf_backend_plt_readonly 1
10481 #undef elf_backend_got_header_size
10482 #define elf_backend_got_header_size 12
10483 #undef elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt
10484 #define elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt 1
10485
10486 #undef bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab
10487
10488 #undef bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create
10489 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create \
10490 ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create
10491 #undef elf_backend_add_symbol_hook
10492 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook \
10493 ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook
10494 #undef elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook
10495 #define elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook \
10496 elf_vxworks_link_output_symbol_hook
10497 #undef elf_backend_final_write_processing
10498 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing \
10499 ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing
10500 #undef elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr
10501 #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr \
10502 ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr
10503 #undef elf_backend_emit_relocs
10504 #define elf_backend_emit_relocs \
10505 elf_vxworks_emit_relocs
10506
10507 #undef elf32_bed
10508 #define elf32_bed ppc_elf_vxworks_bed
10509 #undef elf_backend_post_process_headers
10510
10511 #include "elf32-target.h"
This page took 0.248575 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.